Bạn đang xem bản rút gọn của tài liệu. Xem và tải ngay bản đầy đủ của tài liệu tại đây (1.41 MB, 218 trang )
<span class='text_page_counter'>(1)</span><div class='page_container' data-page=1>
<i><b>Date of preparing :15/ 08 </b></i>
<i>Date of teaching<b>: 17 / 8</b></i>
<b>Period 1 consolidation </b>
<b> I.Teaching points :Students will be able to remind something about grade 7 and know how </b>
to learn well in the new school year .
<i><b>II.Teaching aids : Textbooks , chalks , boards ,posters.</b></i>
<b>I. Organizations(2 ) </b>’ – Greeting and checking attendance .
<b>II. Checking up (7 ) </b>’ –Rewrite some main grammar structures in grade 7 on the board .
- T asks some Ss to go to the board and rewrite .
- T corrects and give marks .
<b>III. New lesson : </b>
<b>Time</b> <b>Teacher</b>’<b><sub>s activities</sub></b> <b><sub>Students</sub>,<sub>activities</sub></b>
I/
1.
2.
II/
<b>The tenses : </b>
<i>- Present simple: </i>
<b>S + V( s/es)/ To be (am/ is /are)</b>
<i><b>- Present progressive :</b></i>
<b> S + To Be + V_ ing +….</b>
<i><b>- Simple future : </b></i>
<b>S + Will/ Shall …</b>
<i>- Near future : </i>
<b>To Be going to….</b>
<i>- Past simple:</i>
<b> S + V( ed/ qkbqt)/To Be( was/ were)....</b>
*Teacher hang a poster, give some forms and uses .
=> Ask Ss to repeat the uses and forms of each tense
Exercise : Change these sentences into other tenses
( Present simple , Present progressive , near future ,
Simple future and Past simple ) and add appropriate
adverbs of time .
1. She is in Grade 7 => ……….
2. They are playing soccer =>………
3. She went to Ha Noi last week =>……….
4. I will visit my sister next week =.>………
5. Mai is going to build a new house .=>………
- Ask Ss to work in pairs
- Call on some pairs to demonstrate in front of class .
- Give feedback
<b>Presenting the English Grade 8 </b>
- There are 16 units in this program , each unit has 6
parts Which mention a particular skill such as
Listening . Speaking , Reading and Writing
+ At the beginning of the unit is “ Getting started “ to
lead in the new lesson or in order to warm up .
-Each unit has Language Focus which help Ss to
summarize basic knowledge they have learnt in each
one .
Introduce some books , reference books to students
-Give some forms and
uses
-Listen and repeat the uses
and forms of them
-Copy down
-work individually
-Work in pairs to practice
- Some pairs to
demonstrate in front of
class.
Listen to the introduction
Work individually
Listen and copy .
-Copy down homeworks.
III/
V/
IV/
<b>Preparation : </b>
- Ask Ss to prepare Unit 1 “ Getting started + Listen
and read “
<b>Consolidations :- Retell the main contents of this </b>
lesson.
<b>Homeworks : </b>
-Learn by heart these old forms .
- Redo all exercises in work books.
- Prepare for next lesson.
Work individually
<b>A / The aims :</b>
<b> I. Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to know more about Hoa</b>
LAN _ Nine and read the dialogue for details and review simple present and simple
past tenses .
<i><b>II. Teaching aids : Text books , cards , cassette , chalk ,poster.</b></i>
<b>B. Steps of the lesson : </b>
<b>I. Organizations (2’) Greeting and checking attendance </b>
<b>II. Checking up (7 )- </b>’ Asks Ss to retell 2 tenses to learned in grade 7.
- T corrects and give marks .
<b>III. New lesson :</b>
<b>Teacher</b>’<b><sub>s activities</sub></b> <b><sub>Students</sub>,<sub>activities</sub></b>
I/
II/
1.
<b> Warm up : Pelmanism </b>
meet come live think send thought
receive met lived received came sent
- Remark and lead in new lesson .
<b> Presentation :</b>
<i> Pre- reading </i>
a) Pre- teach vocabulary : Introduce the aims and
some new words
Work in groups
Listen and write down .
2.
a)
b)
3.
- to seem ( translation )
- a next door neighbor : a person who lives next to
your house
- to look like ( translation )
* Checking vocabulary : Rub out and remember
b) Pre- questions
- Give Ss some questions and ask them to work in
pairs to answer them
1. Is Nien Lan,<sub>s friend or Hoa</sub>,<sub>s friend ?</sub>
2. How old is Nien ?
3. Where does Nien live ?
4. Is she a beautiful girl ?
- Give feedback
<i><b> While </b></i>–<i><b> reading</b></i><b> : </b>
- Turn on the tape 2 times and ask them to read
the dialogue between Hoa , Lan and Nien . Then
check if their answers are correct or not
<i>*Answers: 1-She is Hoa</i>,<sub>s friend . </sub>
2- She is 12 years old ./3- She lives in Hue .
<b> Comprehension questions </b>
- Ask Ss to read the dialogue again and answer the
questions in exercise 2 / page 11
- Have them work in pairs to answer the questions
- Call on some pairs to demonstrate in front of
class and correct their mistakes or pronunciation .
- Correct and give feedback :
a) She lives in Hue
b) No , she does not .
c) The sentence is “ She was not old enough to be
in my class. “
d) At Christmas
- Ask them to work in open pairs to practice
asking and answering the questions and the
<b>dialogue . Gap filling : Language focus 1</b>
- Ask Ss to use the present simple and simple past
tense to complete the paragraph , using some
verbs : live – send – be – come
<i> Hoa ... in Hue last year , but now she ....in Ha </i>
<i>Noi . Yesterday , Hoa ,<sub>s friend Nien ... Hoa a </sub></i>
<i>letter . Nien ... Hoa,<sub> neighbor when Hoa lived in</sub></i>
<i>Hue . She ... younger than Hoa . She ... to Ha </i>
<i>Noi in December . </i>
- Get Ss to work individually and then compare
their answers with their partners .
- Give feedback
lived – lives – sent – was – is - comes .
- Asks Ss do exercise 1(16)
- Call on some Ss to read the completed paragraph
in front of class .
<i><b>Post - reading</b><b> :</b><b> </b><b> Writing </b></i>
- Ask Ss to write a paragraph about Hoa and Lan .
- Give Ss some cues and ask them to use the
Copy down
Play game in whole
class.
Work in pairs
Listen carefully
Repeat all the correct
answers and copy down
Work in pairs
Demonstrate in front of
class.
Practice asking and
answering the questions
and the dialogue .
Complete the paragraph
individually .
Read the complete
paragraph aloud
IV/
V/
simple present or past tense to write individually .
<b>* Cues :</b>
<i>a. Lan / Hoa,<sub>s best friend </sub></i>
<i>b. They / same class / Quang Trung School .</i>
<i>c. Last year / Hoa / to school first time .</i>
<i>friends .</i>
- Let Ss discuss with their partners .
- Choose some answers and correct them in front
of the class .
<b>Consolidations: - Retell the main points of this </b>
lesson.
<b> Homeworks: </b>
1. Rewrite all the answers and complete
paragraph on their notebooks ./ Do Exercise in
workbook .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
Write a paragraph about
Hoa , Lan
Demonstrate in front of
class .
<i>Preparing date:19/08</i>
<b>I. Teaching points :- By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to describe someone .</b>
-Develop Ss’ speaking skill.
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbooks , pictures , chalks, lesson plan ., radio, CD. poster.</b>
<b>I. Organizations (2’) Greeting and checking attendance </b>
<b>II. Checking up (7 ) </b>’ – Asks some ss to go to the board to describe about their friends
- T corrects and give marks .
<b>III. New lesson :( 27 )</b>’
Page 6 School year : 2010- 2011
I.
II/
III/
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
IV/
V/
<i><b>Warm up :* Brainstorming :</b></i>
- Ask Ss to think of the adjectives used to describe
body build and hair .
* Possible answers :
- fat - straight
- slim - long
- tall
- short - Color : black / dark
- overweight blond / fair
- slender brown/grey
<b>Presentation :</b>
- Show Ss a picture of Mary and ask them to describe
her hair , her body build .
Ex : She has long blond hair
She is short and thin
<b>Form S + have / has + adjective + hair</b>
<b>S + be + adjectives</b>
<b>Practice :</b>
Word cue drill
- Prepare 6 cards so that students can drill easily .
a. He / tall / thin
b. She / short / slim
c. He / short / fat
d. Long / black
e. Curly / blond
f. Straight / brown
- Ask Ss to read their complete sentences aloud
- Correct and give feedback
a. He is tall and thin .
b. She is short and slim .
c. He is short and fat .
d. She has long black hair .
e. She has curly blond hair .
f. She has straight brown hair .
Practice speaking
- Ask Ss to look at six people in their books .
- Call on a student to describe one person , the others
have to guess who he / she is
* Example :
S1 : This person is short and thin . She has long blond
hair .
S2 : Is this Mary ? - Yes
- Go on until six people on the poster are
described .
<b>- Post speaking :</b>
<b>* Writing</b>
- Ask Ss to write all the sentences they have described
above .
<b>Pre Listening:</b>
-Asks Ss guess and complete the 4 dialogues(12 +13)
<b>while listening:</b>
-Ss listen and check their prediction.
- Some Ss give answer s.
- T gets feedback .
<b>post listening: </b>
T asks Ss practise the dialouge with their partners.
- T gets feedback.
- Ss work in groups of 5
Work in group
Read all the adjectives
aloud .
Look at the picture and
read the example aloud
Copy and give some
examples .
Work individually
Read the sentences aloud .
Practice speaking in front
of class.
-Write their sentences
alone
Listen and copy .
-Guess and gap fill .
- work individually
- Listen to the radio.
<b>Period 4 Lesson 3 :</b>
<b>I.Teaching points: By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to know more about Ba</b>,<sub>s friend. </sub>
- Develop Ss’ reading skill.
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbooks , cassette , chalks , board, lesson plan ,posters.</b>
<b>B/ Steps of the lesson : </b>
<b>I.</b> <b>Organization : Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II.</b> <b>Checking up :- In the new lesson and give them marks.</b>
<b>III.</b> <b>New lesson:</b>
****
*
1.
2.
<b>Warm up : * Chatting </b>
Ask Ss to look at four pictures on page 10 and talk
about the activities they want to do after school or in
their free time and ask some questions :
1.What are these students doing ?
(play soccer / play chess /read books /play volleyball )
2. What time of the day do you think it is ?
( in the morning / evening , after school )
3. Do you like soccer / reading books ...?
4. Whom do you like playing with ?
- Correct mistakes if any and lead in the new lesson .
<b>Pre - reading : Introduce the aims and some new </b>
words to students
<i> Pre- teach( vocabulary) : </i>
- a character ( translation )
- an orphanage : a place where children without
parents live
- reserved (adj)
- sociable (adj)
- to tell jokes = to tell a story which makes people
laugh
- (a) sense of humor ( translation )
<i>* Checking vocabulary : What and where </i>
- Write the word on the board , put one word in each
circle
<i>T/F statements predictions </i>
- Stick the poster of T / F statements are about Ba and
his friends , read them and guess which statements are
true , which are false :
a. Ba only has three friends – Bao , Song , Khai .
b. Ba and his friends have the same characters .
c. Bao – Song – Khai are quite reserved in public .
d. They all enjoy school and study hard .
- Get Ss to work in pairs
- Call on some Ss to read their predictions and write
them on the board .
Work in groups
Listen carefully
Listen and repeat
Guess its meanings and
copy
Play games
Work in pairs to predict
**
1.
2.
***
IV/
V/
<b>While - reading </b>
- Ask Ss to open their books and read the text carefully
and check their predictions :
<b>- Give feedback a. F b. F c. F d. T</b>
- Ask Ss to correct the false statements
<b>* Correction:</b>
a. Ba has a lot of friends , but he spends most of his
time with Bao , Song . Khai .
b. They have different characters .
c. Only Song and Khai are quite reserved .
+ does not affect his school work : không ảnh hởng tới
việc học
+ rather shy : hơi nhút nhát
+ get tired of : nhàm ch¸n
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to choose the best answers .
- Call on some pairs to report their answers
- Listen and correct . Then give feed back
a. A b. C c . B d. D
<i>* Now answer the questions :</i>
- Let Ss read the text again and work in pairs .
- Call on some pairs of students to ask and answer the
questions
- Correct and give feedback
a. He feels lucky having a lot of friends .
b. Bao is the most sociable
c. Khai likes reading
d. His jokes sometimes annoy his friends .
e. Bao spends his free time doing volunteer work at
local orphanage .
- Let Ss practice asking and answering the questions in
open pairs .
<b>* Post - reading :</b>
- Ask Ss to work in groups and talk to one another
about their friends , using the adjectives they have just
learnt to describe .
- Call on some Ss to demonstrate in front of class.
<b>Consolidation : -Retell the main points of this lesson.</b>
<b>Homework : 1. Write a paragraph about one close </b>
friend ( about 50 words )
2. Do the exercises in workbook .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
Read their predictions
Read the text and check
their predictions
Correct the false
statements and copy
Read the text aloud
( 3 Ss )
Work in pairs to do the
exercise
Read their answers aloud
Copy down
-Practice asking and
answering the questions
Copy the right answers
Work in groups to talk
about their friends
Demonstrate in front of
class.
Listen and copy
<b>Period 5 Lesson 4: </b>
<b>A / The aims </b> :
<b> I. Teaching points:-By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to write a paragraph about their </b>
close friends.
- Develop Ss’ writing skill.
<b>B / Steps of the lesson : </b>
<b>I. Organizations : - Greeting and checking attendance .</b>
<b>II. Checking up : Ask Ss to answer the questions about Bao’s friends .</b>
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III.New lesson :</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>keys:</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
<b> Warm up </b>
<b> ** Slap the board</b>
<i>( Using the words they have learnt in the previous lesson ) </i>
<b> Pre - writing :</b>
<i>* Reading :</i>
- Ask Ss to read the information about Tam , then
answer some questions .
a. What is his name ?
b. How old is he ?
c. What does he look like ?
d. What is he like ?
e. Where does he live ?
f. Whom does he live with ?
g. Who is his friend ?
- Ask Ss to practice asking and answering the
questions above .
- Correct and give feedback .
a. Le Van Tam
b. He is 14
c. he is tall and thin . He has short black hair .
d. He is sociable , humorous and helpful
e. He lives at 26 Tran Phu Street , Ha Noi .
f . He lives with his mother and an elder brother .
g . Ba and Bao
<b> While - writing : </b>
- Let Ss write a paragraph about Tam , using the
information they have just got .
- Work individually . Then compare with the paragraph
in their books .
- Ask Ss to write some information about one of their
friends , then write a paragraph about her / him .
- Get Ss to share with their partners and correct if
possible .
<i>* Sample :</i>
<i> His / her name ... . He / she is ... </i>
<i>years old . He / she ...lives at ... in ... with</i>
<i>... He / she is ... . He / she </i>
<i>has ...hair . He / she is ...helpful . </i>
<i>He / she has ... friends , but his / her close </i>
<i>friends are ... and ... . </i>
- Call on some Ss to read their writings aloud .
<b> Post - writing : </b>
- Ask Ss to write a similar paragraph about himself /
her self
- Go around the class and help Ss , then ask some Ss to
speak in front of class a bout himself / herself.
<b>Consolidation : </b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson .
Play games
Read the information
about Tam .
Practice asking and
answering the questions
Write a paragraph about
Tam individually
Read their writings aloud .
Write another paragraph ,
using the sample .
Demonstrate in front of
class.
Write about himself /
herself .
Listen and copy .
<b>Homework :</b>
1. Write a paragraph about one of their family
members .
2. Learn by heart vocabulary and main points .
3 . Prepare the next lesson .
<b>Period 6 Lesson 5:</b>
<b>A/ The aims :</b>
<b>I.Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to review the simple present tense to </b>
talk about general truths and write some sentences , using the structure “ (not) + adjectives enough +
to infinitive
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbooks , chalks , boards , posters ..</b>
<b>B/ Steps of the lesson: </b>
<b>I. Organizations : Greeting and checking attendance .</b>
<b>II . Checking up : check in the new lesson and give them marks .</b>
<b>III. New lesson :</b>
I/
II/
1.
<b> Warm up : * Kim,<sub>s game </sub></b>
( Using language focus 3 )
- Ask Ss to look at the picture on page 17 quickly .
Then let them keep their books closed .
- Divide the class into four groups .
- Give Ss two questions , the group which answers
correctly the fastest wins the game .
<i>* Questions: </i>
a. How many people are there in the picture ?
( Four )
b. What is each person wearing ?
- The Woman is wearing a red shirt and a green dress.
- The man who is standing beside the car is wearing
brown trousers and a yellow shirt .
- The man who is standing on the pavement is wearing
a pink shirt and blue trousers .
- The boy is wearing blue shorts and a white shirt .
<b>Presentation :</b>
Grammar :
<b>a. Present simple : S + V(es/s)….</b>
eg: I go on holiday twice a year.
- Play game in two teams
Ss answer the T’s
2.
*
**
***
IV/
V/
* Present simple to talk about general truths - It is used
to express an action which is always true .
<b>b. Past simple :</b>
<b>S + V (ed/ qkbqt)/ was / were + ….</b>
eg:I missed the train this morning .
c<b>. (not) adjective + enough + to </b>–<b> infinitive</b>
<b> She is not clever enough to do this thing . </b>
<b>Exercises</b>:
<i><b>Ex 1</b><b> : Complete the paragraphs . Use the correct form </b></i>
of the verbs in brackets
- Ask Ss to work individually and then compare their
answers with their partners .
- Call on some Ss to read their answers aloud .
- Correct and give feedback
a. 1- lives 2- sent 3- was 4- is
b. 1- are 2- came 3- showed 4- introduced
<i>Ex 2 : Complete the dialogue .</i>
- Explain some new words :
+ a planet : the sun , the moon , the earth ...
+ Mars / Mercury ( translation )
+ silly ( adj) ( translation )
- Ask them to read the words in the box .
- Let them complete the dialogue between Ba and Tuan
- Call on some pairs to practice the complete dialogue .
- Correct their pronunciation and give feedback .
* keys :
1- sets 2- goes 3- moves 4- is 5- is 6- is
<i>Ex 4 : Set the scene to introduce the aims of the </i>
exercise :
- Ask Ss to work in pairs
- Call on some pairs to read the complete dialogue
- Correct and give feedback
a. not big enough
b. not old enough
c. strong enough
d. good enough
<b>Consolidation: </b>
<b>- Retell the main contents of this lesson .</b>
<b> Homework :</b>
1. Ask Ss to write five sentences about themselves
, using the structure : (not) + adjective enough +
to – infinitive .
2. Prepare the next lesson
Listen and copy
Read the example and
give some more .
Work individually
Read their answers aloud .
Copy down
Listen and copy
Read the words in the box
and complete the dialogue
.
Practice the dialogue
Copy down
-complete the dialogue
Listen carefully .
Work in pairs
Practice the dialogues
-work in pairs .
-Some Ss to retell the
Listen and copy .
<b> Period 7 lesson 1 </b>
<b>I . Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to use the telephone to make </b>
and confirm arrangements .
- Develop Ss’speaking and listening skills .
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbooks, poster , pictures , radio , CD, lesson plan.</b>
<b>I. Organizations : - Greeting</b> and checking attendance .
<b>II. Checking up: </b>
- Asks Ss to describe the picture , talk about some person in that .
eg :The man is standing next to the car , He is wearing yellow shirt . He is tall and fat .
…
- T corrects and give them marks .
Page 13 School year : 2010- 2011
II/
1.
2.
*
3.
**
***
a. an answering machine
b. a mobile phone
c. a fax machine
d. a telephone directory
e. a public telephone
f. an address book
- Give the definitions of these objects on a poster and
ask Ss to match the object with its definition .
* Definition :
1. to send fax
2. to find someone ,<sub>s telephone number </sub>
3. to write address and telephone numbers
4. to make a phone call in street telephone box .
5. to leave and take messages
6. to make phone call anywhere you like
* Answers : a-5 b-6 c-1 d-2 e- 4 f-3
<b>Pre-teach :</b>
* Elicits and present some words :
- (to) hold on : doi may nhe, giu may cho nhe.
-(to) bit far / alittle bit far : hoi hoi xa, kha xa .
-(an) arrangement : su sap xep .
- ( to ) agree :
<b> Pre- reading :</b>
<i> Open prediction : </i>
- Set the scene “ Hoa and Nga are talking on the phone
. They are talking about going to see a movie “
- Ask Ss to guess :
a. Who made the call ?
b. Who introduced herself ?
c. Who invented the other to the movies ?
d. Who arranged a meeting place ?
e. Who arranged the time ?
f. Who agreed to the time ?
- Have them work in pairs to guess the answers .
- Call on some pairs to report the answers and write
them on the board .
<b> While </b>–<b> reading : </b>
- Turn on the tape 2 times and ask them to read the
conversation between Nga and Hoa , then give them
feedback .
<i>* Answers : </i>
a. Nga made the call
b. Nga introduced herself .
c. Nga invited Hoa to the movies .
d. Nga arranged a meeting place .
e. Hoa arranged the time .
f. Nga agreed the time .
- Get some Ss to read the conversation aloud . Correct
pronunciation if any
<i>Comprehension questions : </i>
- Give Ss some questions and ask them to work in pairs
to answer them . ( T. hang a poster on the board )
1. What is Hoa,<sub>s telephone number ? </sub>
2. Which movie are they going to see ? Where ?
3. How is Hoa going to see the movies ?
4. Where are they going to meet ? What time ?
- Call on some pairs to demonstrate in front of class .
- Remark and give feedback .
<i>* Possible answer :</i>
1. Her telephone number is 3847329.
2. They are going to see the movie Dream City at Sao
Mai Movie Theater .
3. Hoa is going by bike .
4.They are going to meet outside the theater at6.30
- Match each object with
its name
- Give answer keys
Listen and copy down
- Works individually.
-Copy down new words .
- Repeat in chorus
-Listen to teacher sets the
scene .
-Ss guess and answer the
questions .
- Work in pairs.
Work in pairs
Read their predictions
Listen to the tape , read
the conversation to check
their predictions
Practice asking and
answering the questions
- Work in pairs.
Read the conversations
aloud ( in pairs )
Answer the questions.
Demonstrate in front of
class .
<b>Period 8 Lesson 2</b>
<b>A /The aims :</b>
<i><b> I. Teaching points : </b></i>
<b> - By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to talk on the phone about intentions with “ Going </b>
<b>To”</b>
<i><b>II. Teaching aids : Textbooks , cards , chalks , .lesson plan , posters.</b></i>
<b>B / Steps of the lesson : </b>
<i><b>I. Organizations : - Greeting and checking attendance .</b></i>
<i><b>II. Checking up : -T asks some questions : </b></i>
1. Have you got a telephone ?
2. Do you have a telephone at your home ?
- T corrects and give them marks .
<i><b>III. New lesson : </b></i>
I/
II/
1.
<b> Warm up : * Chatting</b>
- Talk to Ss to about using telephone .
1. Do you have a telephone at home ?
2. How often do you make a phone call ?
3. What would you say when you pick up the phone to
answer it ?
4. What would you say if you are the caller ?
<b>Presentation : </b>
<b>Pre- speaking </b>
- Ask Ss to do exercise 1 in pairs to put the sentences in
the correct order to make a complete conversation .
- Call on some pairs to read their answers and write
them on the board :
<i>* Answers : 1-b 2-f 3-j 4-a 5-i 6-c</i>
- Call on some pairs to practice the conversation they
have arranged .
-Ask Ss some questions to check Ss,<sub>understanding and </sub>
focus on the structure GOING TO
a. Are they talking on the phone ?
b. What do they intend to do ?
c. What time are they meeting ? Where ?
-Some ss to answer the T’s
questions
Work in whole class
Work in pairs
Report their answers
Practice the complete
dialogue
- Work in pairs
+ Yes , they are
2.
3.
III/
***
*4.
d. What form of the verbs do you use to talk about
intentions ?
<b>=> </b>
<b>While - speaking : </b>
- Set the scene “ Ba and Bao are making arrangements
to play chess “
- Ask Ss to work with partners to complete the dialogue .
- Call on some pairs to play the roles of Ba and Bao to
practice the dialogue .
- Listen and give feedback
Ba : Hello . 8257012
<i>Bao : May I speak to Ba , please . This is Bao .</i>
Ba : Hello , Bao . How are you ?
<i>Bao : I am fine . Thanks , and you ? </i>
Ba : Great . Me too.
<i>Bao : can you play chess tonight ? </i>
Ba : I am sorry . I can not play chess tonight . I am
going to do my homework .
<i>Bao : What about tomorrow afternoon ? </i>
Ba : Tomorrow afternoon is fine .
<i>Bao : I ll meet you at the Center Chess Club .</i>’
Ba : At the Central Chess Club ? Ok . Let ,<sub>s meet at the </sub>
front door .
<i>Bao : Is 2,00, OK ? </i>
Ba : Great . See you tomorrow afternoon at 2.00 o,<sub>clock .</sub>
<b>Post </b>–<b> speaking</b> : - Ask Ss to make similar dialogue .
T can emphasise (nhan manh )the useful phrases and
sentences
-- Ask Ss to make similar arrangements and practice
talking with a partner .
-Ask Ss to make sentences with “ Going to + Infinitive “
<b>Practice :</b>
<i><b>Model sentences :</b></i>
<i>*Word cue drill :</i>
a. see a movie ( Yes )
b. play / sports ( No )
c. meet your friends ( Yes)
d. help your mother ( Yes )
e. do your homework (No)
f. watch TV ( No )
- Model two cues , then ask Ss to repeat chorally then
individually .
- Ask some Ss to practice asking and answering in pairs.
<i>Language focus 1+2 :</i>
*Ask ss to do ex 1 (25 )
eg : Nga has a movie ticket ( What is she going to do?)
She is going to see a movie .
T . gets feedback and give answer keys .
<i>* Ex 2 ( 25 ) – Ssplay a game : Find someone who </i>…
T asks :
- <i><b>What are you going to do on the weekend ?</b></i>
+ They are meeting inside
the center at 7.15
+ be going to
Listen and copy down.
- work individually.
Listen to teacher carefully
.
Work in pairs
Practice the complete
dialogue
- Work in groups of 3 or 4
Make similar dialogue .
- work in dividually
Practice asking and
answering
- work in pairs .
- Do exercises 1 (25 )
work in pairs
IV/
V/
Are you going to …. ?
+ … meet your friends ?
+…. see a movie ?
+ ….play football ?
+….help your parents ?
+… do ur homeworks ?
+… listen to music/ watch T.V…?.
-T gets feedback .
<b>Consolidations :</b>
Retell contents of this lesson.
<b>Homework : </b>
1.Write five things that they intend to do next week .
And learn by heart main structure grammar .
2.Do exercises in the workbook .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
Do ex 2 (25) .
- Play a game
One by one go around the
- Give the result, Talk
loudly . Others listen to
and corrects mistakes .
- Work individually.
- Some Ss to retell the
main contents.
Listen and copy .down
homeworks.
<b> Period 9 Lesson 3 : </b>
<b>I . Teaching points:</b>By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to complete a telephone message
by listening .
-Listening for details and further practice in adverbs of place.
<b>II. Teaching aids</b> : Textbooks , cassette , chalks , postres, lesson plan.
<b>I . Organizations</b> : - Greeting and checking attendance.
<b>II. Checking up :</b> - Checking in the contents of the new lesson .
- T corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson : </b>
II/
1.
2.
3.
4.
IV/
V/
- Divide Ss into two teams .
- Choose 6 volunteers from each team
- the volunteers stand in two lines . T. shows the first
student a telephone number .
- He / She whispers the telephone number to the next
person in his / her line .
- The second student whispers to the third ... until the
last one .
- The last student has to shout out the number , if it is
the same as the number teacher shows , that team wins
the match .
<b> New lesson : </b>
Revision words:
- Junior high school :Truong THCS _ cap 2
- The principal : hieu truong .
- (to) wanted
- at the moment : ngay lap tuc, 1luc
- (an) appointment: cuoc hen gap
- available : san co, co hieu luc, co gia tri, co mat.
<i>. Pre- listening : </i>
- Ask Ss to look at the form of the telephone message
on page 21 and set the scene “ a woman phoned the
principal of Kingston junior high school , but he was
out .”
- Have Ss guess the message .
- Let Ss work in pairs
- Call on some Ss to read their predictions and write
them on the board .
<i> While - listening : </i>
- Turn on the tape twice and ask Ss to fill in the
message , compare with their predictions .
- Call on some Ss to read their answers after checking .
- T give them marks
* Answers :
<i><b>Kingston junior high school</b></i>
<i><b>Date : ...Time : ...</b></i>
<i><b>For : The principal</b></i>
<i><b>Message : Mrs Mary Nguyen wanted to see you at 9 .</b></i>
<i><b>45 in the morning</b></i>
<i><b>Telephone number : 6463720942.</b></i>
T. corrects and gives answer keys.
- Call on some Ss to read them aloud , Tgive them
marks
<i>Post - listening : </i>
- Ask Ss to make a dialogue about the information they
have heard
- Go around the class and help them .
- Call on some pairs to practice the dialogue they have
made .
<b>Consolidations : </b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson .
<b> Homework : </b>
1. Copy the dialogue above .
2. Do exercise in workbook .
3. Learn by heart the main points and new words.
4. Prepare the next lesson .
Play game
Look at the form of the
telephone message and
listen to the scene
Guess the message
Read their predictions
Listen to tape carefully ,
compare with their
predictions .
- work in pairs.
Read their answers
Work in pairs to make
dialogue .
Practice in front of class
Listen and copy down.
work individually.
- Make a dialogue .
-work individually.
Some Ss Retell the main
contents.
_ copy down homeworks
<b>Period 10 Lesson 4 : Read</b>
<b>I.Teaching points: </b>By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to know more about Alexander
Graham Bell .
- Ss reading for specific ( ro rang , cu the .chi tiet)information about Alex . G .B .
<b>II. Teaching aids :</b> Textbooks , posters , pictures of Bill , lesson plan.
<b>I. Organizations : </b>- Greeting and asks some questions.
<b>II.Checking up : </b>- Asks some Ss to say new words , meaning of these words
- T corrects mistakes and gives them marks.
<b>III.New lesson :</b>
I/
II/
1.
<b> Warm up : * Brainstorming </b>
- Let Ss answer the questions by coming to the board
and write :
To chat with friend
<i><b>+ What is the mobile phone used for ?</b></i>
Possible answers :
- to have a message
- to call someone
- to make arrangements
- to talk to a person who lives far from
- to get information at the airport or railway
station quickly
<b>Pre - reading : </b>
- Introduce the aims and some new words to Ss .
.Pre teach( vocabulary) :
- to emigrate = to go another country to live ( xuat
canh, di cu)
(emigrant:: nguoi xuat canh,song dinh cu o nc ngoai)
- to transmit ( translation )Truyen phat tin hieu.
- to conduct = to carry out:thuc hien, tien hanh, chi
dao, dieu hanh.
- to demonstrate ( translation )= perform.
- a device ( translation ): thiet bi, may moc,
- deaf – mute( adj) = a person who is unable to hear
and speak : tat cam diec..
<i><b>* Checking vocabulary : What and where </b></i>
Play games in 2 teams
Read their answers aloud
and copy .
Listen carefully
2.
III/
*
**
IV/
V/
<i>T / F statements prediction : </i>
- Hang the poster of T / F statements on the board and
ask Ss to work in pairs and guess which statements are
true or false .
.a. Alexander G. Bell was born in the USA
……
.b. He worked with deaf – mute patients in a
……
hospital in Boston .
.c. Thomas Watson was Bell
…… ,<sub>s assistant.</sub>
...d. Bell and Watson introduced the telephone in
…
1877 .
e. Bell experimented his invention at a lot of
……
exhibitions .
- Call on some pairs to read their predictions and write
them on the board .
<b>While - reading : </b>
<i>* True or false : </i>
-Turn on the tape 2 times and ask them to look at their
books to read the text , then check their prediction
Guess Answer Correction
a F He was born in Edinburgh in Scotland
b F He worked with deaf – mute patients
at Boston University
c T
d F He introduced telephone in 1876
e F He experimented with ways of
transmitting speech over a long distance
f T
- Ask some Ss to read the correct answers aloud .
<i>* Ordering : </i>
- Ask Ss to look at the exercise and read the events of
Bell,<sub>s life , then put them in the correct order .</sub>
- Have them compare with their partners
- Call on some Ss to read their answers aloud .
- Corrects and give feedback
= > Alexander Graham Bell
1. Was born in Scotland
2. went to live in Canada
3. went to live in the USA
4. worked with people who could neither speak
nor hear
5. worked with Thomas Watson
6. successfully demonstrate his invention
7. invented the telephone .
- Call on some Ss to read all the correct order
sentences aloud .
<b>Post - reading : * Write it up :</b>
- Get Ss to write a paragraph about Bell,<sub>s life , using </sub>
the information from the text .
- Call on some Ss to demonstrate their writings in front
of class .
- Correct mistakes if any and give Suggestions .
<b>Consolidations: </b>
-Retell the main contents of this lesson.
individually .
Guess its meanings
Copy down
Play game
Look at the poster and
Read their predictions
Listen , read the text , then
check their predictions .
-work in pairs.
- Correct the false ones
(one by one.)
Read them aloud
Do the exercise
Read their answers
work in pairs.
-Read their correct
sentences aloud
-Write individually .
Compare with their
partners .
Read their writings aloud .
VI/
<b> Homework : </b>
1. Copy down their writings .
2. Do the exercises in workbook .
3. Prepare the next lesson . - Copy down homeworks.
<b>Period 11 - lesson 5 : write</b>
<b>I/ Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to write a telephone message .</b>
- Develop Ss’ wrinting skill.
<b>II/ Teaching aids : Textbooks , posters , lesson plan, ... </b>
<b>I/ Organizations: - Greeting and checking attendance .</b>
Page 21 School year : 2010- 2011
<b>I/ </b>
***
<b>II/</b>
<b>1.</b>
**
<b>Keys:</b>
<b>2</b>
eg:
<b>III/</b>
- customer • su phuc vu
- furniture • loi nhan, tin nhan
- stationery • khach hang
- midday • van phong pham
- service • buoi trua, giua ngay.
- message • do dac.
+ T. corrects the mistakes.
<b> Pre - writing : * .Chatting : </b>
– Talk to Ss about taking a telephone message
Have you ever taken a message ,
When you take a message , what should be
( Date , time who sent , to whom , content )
<b> Pre </b>–<b> teach( vocabulary ): </b>
- (a) customer = a person who comes to buy something
at a shop .
- (a) delivery : su giao hang (Trans…)
- stationery ( papers ,pens , pencils , rulers .. ): van
phong pham.
- (to) pick somebody up :don ai bang phuong tien gi …
- (to) taken by :dc nhan boi .
- (to) reach : den, toi gap.
* Checking vocabulary : Rubout and remember
<b> While - writing : </b>
<i>Reading and gap filling </i>
- Ask Ss to read the message and fill in the gaps in the
message .
- Ask them to work in pairs
- Call on some Ss to read their answers aloud .
Corrects and give feedback .
<i><b> A customer phoned/telephoned the Thang Loi </b></i>
<i>Delivery Service on <b>May 12 just before midday . She </b></i>
<i>wanted to <b>speak to Mr Ha but he was out . So Mr Tam</b></i>
<i><b>took a message for Mr Ha . The customer</b>,<sub>s </sub><b><sub>name was</sub></b></i>
<i>Mrs . Lien and she wanted to know about her furniture</i>
<i><b>delivery . She wanted Mr Ha to call her . She said Mr </b></i>
<i><b>Ha could reach her number 8645141 after lunch . </b></i>
- Ask Ss to read the passage 2 to get information and
write the message .
- Let Ss write individually then share with a partner .
- Call on some Ss to read their answers
- Correct and give feedback .
<b>Write : </b>
- Asks Ss to write a message using the
informations from the passage in write (23).
- Asks Ss to share with other groups .
- T. hang some posters of their on the bb.
<i><b>Thanh Cong Delivery Service</b></i>
<i>Date : June 16 </i>
<i>Time : After midday </i>
<i>For : Mrs Van </i>
<i>Message : Mr Nam called about his stationery </i>
<i>order . He wanted you to call him at 8634082</i>
<i>Taken by : Mr Toan . </i>
- Ask Ss to write another message , using the scene “
Tom phoned Nancy , but she was out . Lisa , Nancy ,<sub>s </sub>
sister took a message for Nancy . Help Lisa to write a
message “
- Ask Ss to read the dialogue between Lisa and Tom
then , write the message .
- Let Ss work in pairs .
<b> Post - writing : </b>
- Calls on some Ss to read their answers aloud
Play game
Practice asking and
answering the questions
Listen and repeat in
chorus , individually .
Guess its meanings
Copy down
Play games
Read and do the exercise .
Read their answers aloud
- Work in pairs .
Read the information and
write the message .
Read their answers
Copy down
Write a message , using
the information .
Read the dialogue .
Work in pairs
Read their answers .
<b> </b>
<b>Period 12 : Revision</b>
<b>A / The aims : </b>
<b>I/ Teaching points : </b>- By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to talk about intentions
<i><b>with be going to and know how to use Adverbs of place .</b></i>
- Revision all structure grammar in the old lesson .
<b>II/ Teaching aids : Textbooks , posters , chalks, lesson plan.</b>
<b>B/ Steps of the lesson :</b>
<b>I.</b> <b>Organization : - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II.</b> <b>Checking up : Checking in the New lesson ( asks them to do exercises )</b>
<b>III.</b> <b>New lesson :</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1/</b>
<b>Ex1:</b>
<b>Eg:</b>
<b>Ex2:</b>
<b>2/</b>
<b>Ex3:</b>
<b>Warm up : </b>
<i><b>Telephone transmitting</b></i>
<b> New lesson : </b>
<i>1.Talk about intentions with going to : Introduce the form </i>
<i>and use of going to</i>
- <b>Form : S + be going to + infinitive </b>
- Use : express an intention
Ex 1 :
- Ask Ss to do exercise 1 . They have to work with a
partner and say what the people are going to do .
<b>T : Nga has a movie ticket . What is she going to do ? </b>
<b>S : She is going to see a movie . </b>
- Call on some pairs to read their sentences aloud .
- Correct and give feedback :
a. They are going fishing
b. She is going to read the new model
c. She is going to do her homework .
d.He is going to watch an action movie on TV tonight.
e. She is going to give him a birthday present .
<b>Ex 2 : Complete the list ( Questionnaire ) </b>
a) Ask Ss to work in pairs
- Call on some pairs to demonstrate in front of class .
- Listen and give feedback .
b) Get Ss to work in pairs
- Have some pairs demonstrate in front of class .
- Give feedback .
<i> Adverbs of place * Jumbled words </i>
- Let Ss work individually , one student one word
1. tdeousi = outside / 2. siiden = inside
3. hetre = there / 4. erhe = here
5. stupairs = upstairs .
6. wonstaird = downstairs
- Ask Ss to go to the board and write the meanings words .
- Call on some Ss to read all the adverbs aloud .
<b>Ex 3 : Complete the speech bubbles . Use each adverb in </b>
<b>the box once . </b>
- Set the scene : “ Ba is playing hide and seek with his cousin
, Mr Tuan “
- Let Ss work in pairs , then compare with another pair ( at
their table )
- Call on some Ss to read out the speech bubbles
- Give feedback
Play game
Listen and copy down
Work in pairs
Read the example
Read their complete
sentences
Work in pairs
Stick in column “You “
and Your partner
- Demonstrate in front
of class .
Work individually ,
one student one word
<b>Ex4:</b>
<b>III/ </b>
<b>IV/</b>
<i>a. Where is Tuan ? I think he is upstairs </i>
<i>c. He is not downstairs and he is not upstairs .</i>
<i>d. Perhaps , he is outside . </i>
<i>e. No , he is not there . </i>
<i>f. I am not outside . I am inside , Ba. </i>
- Call on some Ss to read the complete sentences
<b>Use the key words to write meaningful sentences</b>
<b>with BE GOING TO.</b>
Eg: He /be /ready /five.
=>He’s going to be ready at five.
1. men / repair / roof / house /next week.
=>………
2. teacher / explain / next lesson / us / tomorrow .
=>………
3. Mrs.Johnson / wear / new dress / this /
evening ?.
=>………
4. Browns / buy /new house / this year .
=>………
5. My family / visit / my grandparents / Nha trang
/ next month.
=>………
6. We / listen / that radio program / this evening .
=>………
7. I / ask / Mr.Wilson / his / advice / this matter.
=>………
8. They / build / new house / here / August.?
<b>Consolidation :</b>
- Retell the main contents of this lesson .
<b> Homework : </b>
1.Copy the complete exercises in their notebooks .
2. Write six sentences about your house , using adverbs of
place .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
Listen to the scene .
Work in pairs
Read out the speech
bubbles
Read the complete
sentences aloud .
- Work in pairs
then go to the
board to rewrite
the sentence,
using “ be going
to “.
- One by one to
go to the board.
- The others write
down on their
notebooks.
-Retell the main
points.
Copy down
homeworks.
<i><b>Period 13: </b><b> </b></i>
<b>lesson 1 : Getting started + Listen and read</b>
<b> </b>
<b> I . Teaching points : - By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to understand the dialogue </b>
and use modal verbs to talk about the housework .
<b>II. Teaching aids : </b>Textbook , cassette , pictures, postes, lesson plan.
<b>I. Organization : - Greetinmg and checking attendance .</b>
<b>II. Checking up : </b>
-T. asks Ss some questions :
-What did you do to help your mom after school?
- Asks some Ss to answer the questions .
T. corrects and give them marks.
<i>* possible answers :</i>
<i> - cook meas / wash clothes / Tidy up / Feed the chicken / sweep the floor….</i>
<b>III. New lesson :</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>*Form:</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>**</b>
<b> Warm up : * Kim,<sub>s game ( Getting started )</sub></b>
- Show 6 pictures to Ss and ask them to look at 6
pictures quickly in 30 seconds and try to remember
the verbs in the pictures as many as possible
- Which team remembering more verbs is the winner.
Answer :
a. Wash dishes / do the washing up
b. Make the bed / to fold the clothes neatly( gap quan
ao ngay ngan)
c. Sweep the floor ./d. Cook / e. Tidy up
f. Feed the chicken
<b>* Presentation : Introduce the topic of the passage </b>
and some new words
<b>* Pre- teach (Vocabulary ): </b>
- (a) steamer : noi hap, noi dun hoi.
-( a) cupboard : chan , tủ chạn
-( a) saucepan : chảo
- chore (n) : viec vat trong nha, cong viec noi tro.
-( a) sink : bon rua, chau rua.
<i><b>* Checking techniques : What and where </b></i>
- Set the scene of the dialogue between Nam and his
mother , Mrs Vui .
- Ask Ss to complete the list of the things Nam has to
do .
- Turn on the tape and ask Ss to look at their books
and read their complete sentences :
<i><b> * Nam has to: </b></i>
<i><b> - cook dinner .</b></i>
<i><b> - go to the market to buy fish and vegestables.</b></i>
<i><b> - call his Aunt , Ms Chi and ask her to meet his </b></i>
<i><b>mother at grandma</b><b>,</b><b><sub>s house .</sub></b></i>
<b>Has / Have to + Infinitive = Must + Infinitive </b>
<b> Model : What do you have to do ? </b>
I must do the washing up .
a. do the washing up / b. make the bed
c. sweep the floor /d. cook dinner
e. tidy my room / f. feed the chickens .
- Call on some Ss to practice in front of class
* Have Ss to practice the dialogue in pairs .
<b>Language focus 3 : - Reflexive pronouns :</b>
<b>Form: I -> myself./ We -> ourselves / </b>…
<b>Usage :</b>
<b>Ex ercise: Asks Ss to do exercise 3 (35).</b>
- Complete the dialogues.
- T. corrects and give answer keys.
<b>+ Production : </b>
- Ask Ss to write the lists of the things they have to do
Play game
_ Some Ss stand up and
speak loudly.
- Copy new lesson.
- read in chorus.
Listen and copy down .
Repeat in chorus and
Guess its meanings and
copy
Play game
Listen carefully
Listen to the tape while
looking at their books .
Read their sentences they
have completed
Copy and give examples
Practice in pairs
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
on Sundays .
<i>Beginning with : On Sunday morning , I have to tidy </i>
my room ...
- Call on some Ss to read their writings in front of
class.
- Correct mistakes if any and ask them to copy .
<b>Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main contents of this leson .
<b> Homework : </b>
1. Learn by heart all new words they have learnt .
2. Do their exercises in workbook .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
Write individually
Demonstrate their writings
Listen and copydown
homeworks .
<b>Period 14</b> <b> Lesson 2 </b>
<b>I. Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to use the prepositions of places</b>
to talk about the positions in the house .
- Develop’s Ss speaking skill.
<b>II. Teaching aids : Pictures , chalks , leson plan, poster.</b>
<b>B/ Steps of the lesson: </b>
<b>I. Organizations: - Greeting and checking attendance .</b>
<b>II. Checking up :Asks some Ss to retell the new words of last lesson.</b>
- T. corrects and give marks.
<b>III. New lesson : </b>
***
I/
<b>Warm up : * Kim,<sub>sgame</sub></b>
- Devide the class into 2 teams
- Show the picture of a chicken to Ss .
- Ask them to study the things in the picture
- Take away the picture and ask Ss to write down
as many things as they can remember .
- Which team having more things win games .
<b> Pre - Speaking : </b>
- Ask Ss the positions of the items in the pictures .
Where is the rice cooker ? It is next to the bwl of fruit .
Where is the cupboard ? It is on the wall , above the
counter .
Where are the knives ? They are on the wall , under
the cupboard .
Where is the dish rack ? It is on the counter , next to
Play game
Practice asking and
answering about the
II/
III/
***
IV/
V/
the bowl of fruit .
- Call on some pairs to practice asking and answering
<b> While - speaking : </b>
- Get Ss to work in pairs , talking about the position of
each item
Ex : The calendar is on the wall , above the stove . -
Call on some pairs to demonstrate in front of class.
- Give feedback :
+ The sink is next to the stove .
+ The cupboard is on the wall , above the counter .
+ The knives are on the wall , under the cupboard .
+ The bowl of fruit is between the rice cooker and the
dish rack .
+ The clock is on the wall , above the fridge .
+ The flowers are on the table .
- Ask them to read all the suggested sentences aloud .
<b> Post - speaking : </b>
- Set the scene : Mrs Vui bought new furniture
for her living room , but she can not decide
where to put it . You should help her to arrange
the furniture”
- Ask Ss to look at the picture and talk about their
Ask Ss to practice speaking :
- If they agree , they may use :
Ok
You are right
- If they disagree , they may use :
No , I think we ,<sub>d better / ought to put ...</sub>
I think it should be ...
Example :
- Let us put the clock on the wall , between the shelf
and the picture .
- OK . I think we ought to put the TV and the stereo on
the shelf …..
- Call on some pairs to practice speaking .
<b>Consolidation : - Retell the main contents of this </b>
lesson.
<b> Homework : </b>
1. Describe their living room or bedroom .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
positions of each item .
Work in pairs
Read all the sentences
aloud .
Listen carefully .
Copy down
Read the examples
Practice speaking .
Listen and copy .
<b>Period 15 lesson 3 </b>
<b>I .Teching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to identify the right item by </b>
- Develop Ss listening skill.
<b>II. Teaching aids : Cassette , textbooks , chalks , lesson plan , poster .</b>
<b>I. Organization : - Greeting and checking attendance .</b>
<b>II. Checking up :</b>
- Asks Ss complete the list of things Nam has to do ex2 ( 28 ) – 2 Students to talk.
- Two others Use “ought to” to give advice b- d (35).
+ T corrects and give answer keys .=> give them marks .
<i>* Keys ( possible answer):</i>
1) - He has to go to the market to buy fish and vegetables.
- He has to call Aunt Chi ask her to meet his mother at his grandma’s house .
2) – b- You ought to get up earlier.
- d – You ought to go to a dentist .
<b>III. New lesson :</b>
***
I/
II/
III/
<b> Warm up : * Bingo</b>
- Ask Ss to write down on their notebooks 5
things you can eat .
- Prepare a list of food . Then call out each word
in a loud voice .
- Ss listen to the teacher carefully . If anyone has
the same things , they cross them out . The first
person crossing out all 5 things shouts “ Bingo “
and wins the game .
Suggested list of food : Chickens , beef , cake ,
candy , garlic , noodles , bread , rice , ham ,
peas ...
<b> Pre - listening : </b>
* Predictions :
- Get Ss to look at page 30 and guess 4 things they use
to cook the Special Chinese Fried Rice “
- Call on Ss to read their predictions and write them on
the board .
<b>While - listening : </b>
- Turn on the tape 3 times and ask them to check their
predictions .
- Give feedback
a. Fired Rice
b. Pan
c. Garlic and green peppers
d. Ham and peas .
- Turn on the tape once more to check the answers
again .
<b> Post - listening :</b><i><b> Mapped dialogue </b></i>
- Ask Ss to play the roles of Lan and Mrs Tu to
make a dialogue by listening the tape again .
Play game
-Look at their books and
guess 4 things , they use
to cook the “ Special
Chinese Fried Rice “
- Read their predictions
Listen to the tape
carefully to check their
Copy the answers .
Listen and check once
more .
Listen individually
Practice in pairs to make a
dialogue .
IV/
V/
<i><b>Lan : Can I help ..., Mom ?</b></i>
<i><b>Mrs Tu : Sure you can cook ...</b></i>
<i><b>Use the big pan please .</b></i>
<i><b>Lan : ...?</b></i>
<i><b>Mrs Tu : Just a little . Wait until it is hot and then fry</b></i>
<i><b>the garlic and the green peppers .</b></i>
<i><b>Lan : ...?</b></i>
<i><b>Mrs Tu : Yes . And you can put the rice and s </b></i>
<i><b>teaspoon of salt in .</b></i>
<i><b>Lan : YUmmy ! It smells ... .</b></i>
- Call on some pairs to practice the dialogue in front
of class .
- Correct pronunciations if any .
<b>Consolidations: </b>
Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b> Homework : </b>
1. Copy down the dialogue in their notebooks .
2. Do exercise ... in workbook .
3 . Prepare the next lesson .
Work inpairs
Practice in front of class
Listen and copy .
- Work individually
- copy down homeworks.
<b>Period 16 Lesson 4</b>
<b>I. Teaching points</b> : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to understand the safety
precautions in the house and use Why- because .
- Develop Ss’ reading skill.
<b>II. Teaching aids</b> : Textbooks , Cassette , pictures , realias , lesson plan
<b>I. Organization : Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up:</b> Asks Ss talk some steps to make the “Special Chinese Fried Rice”.
- T corrects and give them marks
<i><b>*Possible answers : </b></i>
1.Put the little oil in the big pan.
2. Heat the pan.
3. Fry the garlic and the green peppers.
4. Put the ham and peas in .
Page 29 School year : 2010- 2011
I/
***
***
II/
1.
2
III/
V/
knife./ bead / glass …
<i><b> Things danger</b></i>
<i><b> in home for children.</b></i>
- Ask them to copy down .
<b> Pre - reading : Introduce the topic of the passage </b>
reading and some new words to Ss
Pre – teach vocabulary :
- a precaution = sự phòng ngừa , sự đè phòng
- a socket ( realia ) / a bead : vat tron nho
- a match ( realia )
- an object = vật , đồ vật
- safety (n ) = sự an toàn
- to destroy = phá huỷ
- to injure ( situation ) : Gay thuong tich
<b>* Checking : Slap the board </b>
True / false statements predictions
- Ask Ss to read the statements and guess which is
true , which is false .
<b>Statements</b> <b>Guess</b> <b>Key</b>
1. It is safe to leave medicine
around the house .
2. Drugs can look like candy .
3. A kitchen is a suitable place
to play .
4. Playing with one match can
not start a fife .
5. Putting a knife into an
electrical socket is dangerous .
6. Young children do not
understand that many house
hold objects are dangerous .
F
T
F
- Call on Ss to read their predictions and write them
on the board .
<b>While - reading : </b>
Reading the text :
- Turn on the tape , Ss look at poster to check their
prediction.
- Have them correct the statements which are false
1. It is safe to keep medicine in locked cupboards .
3. A kitchen is dangerous place to play .
4. Playing with one match can cause fire.
- Call on some Ss to read the text aloud ( 2 Ss )
2. Comprehension questions :
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to find out the answers of
these questions .
- Call on some pairs to practice asking and answering
the questions .
- Give feedback
a. Because children often try to eat and drink them
e. Because the dangerous objects can injure or kill
children .
<b> Post - Reading : * Discussion </b>
- Ask Ss to work in groups,discussing about the topic .
1. Safety precautions in the street .
2. Safety precautions at school .
Play game in two teams
Write down
Listen to the topic .
Listen and repeat in
chorus and individually
Guess its meaning s and
copy
Play game in 2 teams
Read and predict
Read their predictions
Listen to the tape . look at
the poster to check their
predictions .
- Correct the false ones .
- Read the aloud
Practice asking and
answering the questions
Work in groups to discuss
about the topic .
- Demonstrate in front of
class.
<b>Period 17 lesson 5 : </b>
<b> I . Teaching points:</b>By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to write a description of
a room in their house .
- Develop Ss writing skill .
<b>II. Teaching aids :</b> Textbooks , chalks , board , lesson plan.
<b>I. Organization :</b> Greeting and checking attendance.
<b>II. Checking up:</b> Asks 2 Ss to say some things danger in home for children.
- T. corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson :</b>
***
I/
1.
2.
II/
<b>Warm up : * Chatting</b>
<i>( Asking something about the room on page 32 )</i>
1. Which room is this ?
2. What is this ? / Where is it ?
<b> Pre - writing : Introduce the aims and some new </b>
words to Ss :
<i> Pre- teach vocabulary : </i>
- folder (n)bia (dung de cat dan thu cong)
- beneath : (pre) Khoang duoi > < above.
- dish rack (n) gia de bat dia.
- lighting fixture (n) den chum
- Container : (n) cai dung , cai chua ( chai , lo,
binh…)
<b>* Checking : Rub out and remember </b>
Reading
- Ask Ss to read the description of Hoa,<sub>sroom , then </sub>
ask some comprehension questions
a. What is there on the left of the room ?
b. Where is the bookshelf ?
c. What is there on the right side of the room ?
d. Where is the wardrobe ?
- Call on some pairs to practice in front of class .
- Correct and give feedback :
a. There is a desk on the left of the room .
b. The bookshelf is above the desk .
c. There is a window on the right side of the room .
d. The wardrobe is beside the window and opposite the
desk .
- Call on some Ss to read the descriptions of Hoa,<sub>s </sub>
room aloud .
<b> While - writing : </b>
- Ask Ss to describe Hoa,<sub>s kitchen , using the given </sub>
cues .
- Ask Ss to share with their partners .
- Call on some Ss to demonstrate their writings in front
of class .
- Correct the mistakes from some descriptions if any .
Play game
Listen and copy the title
of the lesson .
Listen and repeat in
chorus , individually .
Guess its meanings and
copy .
Play game
Read the description and
practice asking and
answering the questions
- work in pairs.
Read the description aloud
.
Work individually
Compare with their
friends
III/
IV/
V/
- Give feedback
<i><b>This is Hoa</b><b>,</b><b><sub>s kitchen . </sub></b></i>
<i><b>There is a refrigerator in the right corner of the </b></i>
<i><b>room . </b></i>
<i><b>Next to the refrigerator are the stove and the oven </b></i>
<i><b>On the other side of the oven , there is a sink and </b></i>
<i><b>next to the sink is a towel rack . </b></i>
<i><b>The disk rack stands on the counter , on the right of </b></i>
<i><b>the window and beneath the selves . </b></i>
<i><b>On the selves and on the counter beneath the </b></i>
<i><b>window, there are jars of sugar , flour and tea . </b></i>
<i><b>In the middle of the kitchen , there are a table and </b></i>
<i><b>four chairs . </b></i>
<i><b>The lighting fixture is above the table , and directly </b></i>
<i><b>beneath the lighting fixture is a vase with flowers . </b></i>
- Call on some Ss to read the completed descriptions
aloud .
<b>Post- writing : * Speaking </b>
- Ask Ss to talk to their partners about their room /
living room / kitchen .
- Call on some Ss to demonstrate their speeches in
front of class .
<b>Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main contents of this lesoon.
<b> Homework</b> :
1. Write a description of their living room .
2. Do exercises in workbook .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
<b>* Feedback : </b>
- Describe the
Hoa’skitchen.
- Work individually.
Read the completed
writing aloud .
(one by one)
Practice speaking .
Demonstrate in front of
class .
Listen and copy
<b>Period 18 lesson 6 </b>
<b>I. Teaching points :</b> By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to use the Reflexive
Pronouns , modal verbs to talk about the house work and know how to use Why - Because .
<b>I. Organization:</b> - Greeting and Ask some questions.
<b>II. Checking up</b>: T. asks some Qs in Ex2 (32).
- Ss answer the questions.
- T. corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson :</b>
*** <b> Warm up : * Brainstorming </b>
- tidy up
- do our homework
I/
1.
*
2.
II/
**
*
Things you - cook
can do - water flower
- clean the floor
- repair the machine
- fix the TV set
Things you - paint the house
can not do -
-
- Call on some Ss to talk with “ Can “
- Listen and correct mistakes if any
<b> Language focus : </b>
1. Reflexive pronouns
- Set the scene “ You do your homework and no one
helps you . What do you say ? “
I did my homework myself .
-> Explain the reflexive Pronouns
<b>- > Form : We use I with myself </b>
You ... yourself / yourselves
He ...himself
She ...herself
We ...ourselves
They ... themselves
It ... itself
- Emphasis( nhan manh, tam quan trong) pronouns :
Used to emphasize a person or a thing .
Eg : She cut herself .
John saw himself in the mirror .
Complete the dialogue :
- Ask Ss to fill in the blanks with suitable reflexive
pronouns or emphasis pronouns .
- Call on some pairs to practice speaking .
- Give feedback :
a. himself b. ourselves c. myself / yourself
d. himself / herself / themselves e. yourself .
- Ask them to practice the complete dialogue .
2. Modal verbs
- Set the scene : “ Hoa is very sad because she failed
her English test . What do you say to advise her ? “
“ You should study harder “
Another word for “ should “ : Ought to
Ought to + Infinitive
<b>Exercises:</b>
- Ex 2 : Ask Ss to give advice to people in the pictures
- Call on some pairs to practice in front of class .
- Give feedback :
a. I failed my English test .
You ought to study harder
b. You ought to get up earlier .
c. You ought to eat more fruit and vegetables .
d. You ought to see a dentist .
<b>* Checking : Noughts and crosses : </b>
His tooth / ache Hoa / late My room / untidy
The floor / dirty Bao / overweight She / thin
My English / bad Hergrades / bad The washing
machine / not
work
Using “ Should “ to play game .
Ex 1 : Look at the pictures . Complete the dialogue ,
Play game in two teams.
- one by one of each team
to talk.
Talk the things you can do
Listen to the scene and
answer the questions .
-- Work individually.
Write down and give
examples
- Work in pairs to
complete the dialogue
- Practice speaking
- Wrks in pairs.
Listen and copy
**
III/
IV/
Use Must or Have to and the verbs in the box :
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to practice the dialogue :
- Call on some pairs to demonstrate in front of class.
- Give feedback
1. must / have to tidy ; 2. have to / must dust
3. must / have to sweep ; 4. must / have to clean
1. Do exercise 4 ( language focus 4 )
2. Copy all the exercises above .
3. Prepare the test .
<b>Feedback : </b>
Play game in two teams.
Work in pairs
-> Demonstrate in front of
class .
Listen and copy .
<b>Period 19 </b>
<b>I. Teaching Points : </b>
- By the end of the lesson, Ss will be able to consolidate all structure grammar from unit
1 to unit 3 .They can to do all exercises in work book.
- Develop Ss’ 4 skills ( listening, Speaking, reading and writing.)
<b>II. Preparation</b>:
Lesson plan, textbook, posters...
<b>I.Organization :</b> - Greeting and checking attendance.
<b>II. Checking up:</b> - Asks some Ss retell some structure grammar from unit 1to unit 3.
-T. copy down on the board.
- T.hang a poster give main structure grammar, and give them marks.III.
<b>III.New lesson:</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>Ex1:</b>
<b>New lesson : Asks Ss to do exercises. Using some old </b>
structure grammar.( T hang a poster , give some
Structure Grammar)
Ex 1 : <i><b>1. Choose the best answer to complete the sentences:</b></i>
1. He’s tall and thin. He has _______
A. black hair short B. short black hair
C. hair short black D. black short hair
2. I find he is not communicative. He’s rather _____.
C. sociable D. reserved
3. Don’t let your little brother play with the ballpoint
pen. It can _________________him.
A. move B. sweep
C. injure D. destroy
4. The lighting fixture is ______ the dinner table.
A. above B. on
C. beneath D. under
5. He’ll ____________cook meals himself.
A. can B. must
C. have to D. ought to
6. Deaf-mutes can _______speak ________hear.
A. both – and B. either – or
C. neither – nor D. not only – but also
7. Our son is old enough to look after _______.
A. himself B. herself
Play game
Listen and copy down
Work in pairs
Read the example
Read their complete
sentences
<b>Ex2:</b>
<b>Ex3:</b>
<b>III/ </b>
<b>IV/</b>
C. myself D. ourselves
8. Don’t come in. Please wait _______for your turn.
A. inside B. outside
C. upstairs D. downstairs
9. Alexander Graham Bell was born ________March,
3, 1847.
A. at B. in
C. on D. from
10. Would you like to go to the concert with me tonight?
- _____________________.
A. Yes, please B. No, thanks
C. I’m sorry. I’d love to D. Yes. I’d love to
<i><b>2 Rewrite each sentence keeping the same meaing: </b></i>
1. Your little brother can’t study in this school because he
is still young.
Your little brother isn’t __________________
2. Her hair is short, curly and blonde.
She has______________________________
3. Driving too fast is very dangerous.
It __________________________________
4. Do you plan to invite her to your birthday party ?
Are _______________________________
Ask Ss to do exercise.They have to work with a partner
and say what the people are going to do .
- Ask Ss to go to the board to do exercises.
<i><b>3. Look at the piture and describe the bedroom with the </b></i>
<i><b>things below:</b></i>
0. This is my Lan’s bedroom
3. The bed / the middle / the room
4. On the right side / the room there / a window
5. The clock / the wall, / the bed
6. The bookshelf / the wall, /the desk
7. The wardrobe / the desk
8. The cushion / the bed
<b>Consolidation :</b>
- Retell the main contents of this lesson .
<b> Homework : </b>
1.Copy the complete exercises in their notebooks .
2. Write six sentences about your house , using
adverbs of place .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
Work in pairs
- Choose the best answer.
- Demonstrate in front of
class .
Work individually , one
student one word
Go to the board to write
the meanings and read
them aloud .
Listen to the scene .
Work in pairs
Read out the speech
bubbles
Read the complete
sentences aloud .
Copy down .
Do exercise 4 .
- Work in pairs .
Describe the
picture.
- One by one to talk
loudly
- The others write
down on their
notebooks.
-Retell the main points.
Copy down homeworks.
<b>§20:TEST (45’)</b>
<b>ENGLISH 8 (NO :1)</b>
<i><b>Name: </b><b>………</b><b>.</b></i>
<i><b>Class : </b><b>… ………</b><b>8</b></i>
<i><b>I. Choose the best answer a ,b ,c or d. (3p).</b></i>
1)The sun in the East.
a.rise b.rises c.rose d.rising
2)Last year, Hoa in Hue.
a.live b.lives c.lived d.living
3) you going to see a movie ? - yes,I am.
a.do b.are c.did d.will
4) Who made this dress for her ? - She made it .
a .by her b. her c )herself d .hers
5) is Nam absent today?- Because he’s tired.
a.why b.what c.where d.when
6) Now, Lan to do her homework.
a.must b.have d.have to d.has.
<i><b>II.Correct the following sentences.Each sentence has one mistake(2p)</b></i>
1.Let’s us meet outside the cinema.=>………..
<b>III. Read the text and fill the gap True(T) or False(F). (2p ):</b>
“ I am peter. I’m going to look for a new job and a new flat next month. I’m going to
look in the newspapers and ask all my friends for help.I’d like to move to a quieter
town because I can’t stand the noise . I’m going to stay where I am this time next year
– I know that .”
1. Peter is living in a noisy town .
2. He is not going to change his job.
3. He thinks that his friends will help him .
4. He’s going to live in another town this time next year.
1. ________ . 2. ________ . 3 . _________ . 4 . _________.
<b>IV.Describe your close friend ( about five sentenses) : (3p )</b>
- What is his / her name ? . How old is he / she ? what does he / she look like ? what
does he / she like ? what does he / she ofen wear ?
chữ kí giáo viên ch÷ kÝ phơ huynh
…………... ..………
<i><b>Testing date : 10 / 10 / 2008 .</b></i>
<b>Period 20 :</b>
<b> I. Teaching points:</b> Ss will be able to summarize the knowledge they have learnt to do the
test well .
<b>II. Teaching aids :</b> Papers , chalks and boards .
<b> I. Organization:</b>
<b>II. checking up:</b>
<b>III. Contents:</b>
I / Complete these sentences with the suitable words or phrases in the brackets (3P)
1. I ( read / am reading / am going to read )a book about astrology at the moment
2. We ( go / are going / will go ) to a party on Saturday .
3. Nurses ( look / are looking / are going to look ) after people in hospital .
4. Jane ( comes / is coming / will come ) form Ireland .
5. I( speak / am speaking / will speak ) speak four languages .
6. ( Do you want / are going to want / are wanting ) to go out tonight ?
II / Put the sentences into the right order to make a logical dialogue : ( 2p )
a. Yes , I am
b. Isn,<sub>t that Lan</sub>,<sub>s father , my dear ? </sub>
c. How do you do ?
d. Excuse me ! Are you Mr Viet ?
e. I am not sure . Go and ask him .
f. I am Nam – Hoa,<sub>s father </sub>
1…... 2……. 3……. 4…….. 5……... 6…….
III / Rewrite these sentences , beginning as shown , so that the meaning stays the same ( 2P )
<b>1. He is not tall , so he can not reach the shelf . => He is not ………..</b>
<b>2. The book was interesting . I read it twice . => The book was interesting ……..</b>
<b>3. I will phone you tomorrow morning . => I will give ……….</b>
<b>4. Putting a knife into an electrical socket is dangerous . => It is dangerous ……</b>
IV / Write a paragraph about Lan , using the information in the table : (3p )
Name : Nguyen Huong Lan
Appearance : thin , tall , short black hair
Characters : friendly , humorous , helpful
Address : 25 Quang Trung Street , Nam Dinh
Family : mother , father , younge sister – Hai
Friends : Mai and Ba
<b>Keys</b>
I / 1,5 ps Ss get 0,25 ps for each correct one
1. am reading 2. are going 3. look 4. comes 5. speak 6. Do you want
1. d 2. a 3 . c 4 . f 5. b 6. e
III / 2,0 Ss get o0,5 ps for each correct one
1. He is not tall enough to reach the shelf .
2. The book was interesting enough foe me to read twice .
3. I will give you a ring tomorrow morning .
4. Is is dangerous to put a knife into an electrical socket
V / 2,o ps
+ Tape script :
<i> A customer telephoned the Thanh Cong Delivery Service on may 11 just twelve o,<sub>clock . </sub></i>
<i>The customer,<sub>s name was Mr Nam , and he wanted to speak to Mrs Van . Mrs Van was in a </sub></i>
<i>meeting and could not come to the phone . So Ms Toan took a message . Mr Nam called about</i>
<i>his stationery order . He said Mrs Van could reach him at 884 . 846. </i>
<b>Period 21 lesson 1</b>
<b>A The aims :</b>
<b> I. Teaching points: By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to tell the activities people used </b>
to do in the past .
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbook , cassette , chalks, leson plan, picture.</b>
<b>B/ Steps of the leson :</b>
<b>I. Organization : - Greeting .</b>
<b>II. Checking up :</b>
- Asks Ssretell some structures grammar of last lesson .
- T corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson :</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b> Warm up : * Getting started </b>
- Ask Ss to look at the picture and write the names of the
things that do not belong to the past .
* Answers :
- The TV / The radio / The mobile / The light fixture
- Modern clothing / school uniforms
<b> Pre - reading : </b>
Pre- teach vocabulary
- used to + v : da tung ( trans…)
Play game in two
teams.
-One by one go to the
board.
<b>2.</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>a.</b>
<b>b.</b>
<b>c.</b>
<b>d.</b>
<b>e.</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
- to look after = to take care of
- (an)Equipment (n) Trang thiet bi - example
- a folktale : Tam Cam is a folk tale : chuyen dan gian.
- (a) tale: chuyen co tich ( explain..)
- Traditional ( adj ) thuoc ve truyen thong. (trans.. )
-( a) great grandfa / great grandma(n)cụ ông / cụ bà.
- Lost : (v) mất. / Lit(v) thắp , đốt ( đèn) ( .explain)
T / F statements prediction
- Ask Ss to read the statements and predict they are true or
false .
Statements Guess Key
1. Nga is used to live on farm
2. Nga ,<sub>s grandma did not go to school .</sub>
3. She has an easy and happy life when
she was young .
4. There was not any modern equipment
at her time .
5. “ The lost shoe “ is a short story
F
T
F
T
F
- Call on Ss to read their predictions and write them on the
board .
<b>While - reading : </b>
- Turn on the tape 2 times and look at their books to read
the dialogue between Nga and her Grandma to check their
predictions
- Ask them to correct the false statements .
1. Grandma used to love on farm
3. She had a hard life .
5. It is an old folk tale .
<b>* Comprehension :</b>
- Get Ss to work in pairs , asking and answering questions
- Give feedback
a. She used to live on a farm .
b. Because she had to stay at home and help her Mom to
look after her younger brothers and sisters .
c. She used to cook the meals , clean the house and wash
the clothes .
d. Her great grandma used to lit the lamp and her great
father used to tell stories .
e.She asked her grandma to tell her the tale“The lost shoe“
- Ask Ss to practice asking and answering the questions .
<b>* Fact or opinion </b>
- Have Ss read the statements part 3 and decide which
is a fact and which is a pinion .
<b>Statements</b> <b>Fact</b> <b>Opinion</b>
a. I used to live on a farm .
b. There was not any electricity .
c. Mom had to do everything without
the help of modern equipment .
d. My father used to tell us stories
e. The best one was the lost shoe .
f. Traditional stories are great .
X
X
X
X X
X
- Give feedback
<b> Post - reading : * Survey </b>
Did you use to ...? Name
Get up late. / Ride bicycle too fast .
Go to school. / Eat too much candy .
Listen and repeat in
chorus , individually .
Guess its meanings
and copy down
Play game
Work in groups
- read the statements
and predict.
-Read their
predictions
Listen to the tape and
look at their books to
check their
predictions
- Correct the false
ones
- work in pairs
Practice asking and
answering the
questions .
Read the statements
and decide which is a
- Practice in groups
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
Forget to do your homework .
- Give feedback by asking Ss some questions to check “
Who used to get up late / ride bicycle too fast ...? “
- Write it down .
<b>Consolidation: Retell the main points .</b>
<b>Homework : </b>
1. Write the result of their survey .
2. Learn by heart new words .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
Listen and copy .
- Retell the main
points.
- Copy down home
works.
<b>Period 22 lesson 2</b>
<b> </b>
<b> I.Teaching points</b> : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to use USED TO to talk about
the things they used to do .
<b>II. Teaching aids :</b> Textbooks , word cards for drilling, lesson plan, poster.
<b>I. Organization:</b> - Greeting and ask some questions.
<b>II. Checking up:</b> - Ask Ss to stand up and retell new words of last lesson.( say about the
meaning, form.)
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson :</b>
***
I/
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
<b> Warm up : Jumbled words </b>
- rieletcicty = Electricity
- menttaenterin = Entertainment
- rkmaet = Market
- permasuekt = Supermarket
<b> Pre - speaking : </b>
Recall the conversation between Nga and her
grandma , then ask “ Where did Nga,<sub>s grandma </sub>
always live ? “ -> She always lived on a farm .
<i>- Ask : “ Another word for always lived “ .</i>
Ask Ss to use Used to to make question and answer.
“ Where did Nga ,<sub>s grandma use to live ? “ </sub>
She used to live on a farm .
Form : S + Used to + inf
S + did not use to + inf
Did + S + use to + inf ?
Expressing a past habit , or an action usually
Practice
Word cue drill
a. Live / Hue / Hanoi
b. Have / long hairs / short hairs
c. Get up / late / early
d. Walk to school / bicycle
e. Study / evening / early morning
Play games
- One by one to go to the
board to write.
Practice reading the
conversation and answer
the questions
Listen and copy
- Practise in pairs
II/
1.
***
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
III/
IV/
V./
- Call on some pairs to practice asking and answering
the cues above .
<b>While - speaking : </b>
- Get Ss to work in closed pairs , then open pairs .
- Ask them to compare 2 pictures , using “ USED TO “
to talk about the actions in the past , using these ideas
below :
1. Where did they live in the past ? And now ?
3. What is about the electricity ?
4. What is about their life / work ?
5. Did children use to go to school ?
6. What is about their entertainment ?
- Call on some pairs to demonstrate in front of class
- Give feedback .
<i>* Suggested answers : </i>
1. People used to live in small houses . Now they live in
big houses and buildings.
2. People used to walk . Now they can go by cars or
motorbikes .
3. Now , there is electricity everywhere .
4. People used to work hard all the time . Now they
have a lot of time for entertainment .
5. Most children used to stay at home . Now , they all go
to school .
6. Children used to play traditional games such as hide
and seek , skip rope ... outdoors . Now , they have a lot
of modern games – video games .
<b> Post - speaking : * Write it up</b>
- Ask Them to write a complete writing about the
difference of the life in the past and now.
- Call on some Ss to demonstrate in front of class .
- Correct common mistakes .
<b>Consolidation:</b>
Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>Homework : </b>
1. Write about the things you used to do last year .
<i>Beginning : Last year , I used to get up late . Now , I get</i>
up very early and do morning exercises . ... ... “
2. Do exercise in workbook .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
Practice speaking with
cues
Work in pairs
Demonstrate in front of
class
- One by one
- copy down if necessary
Work individually .
- Retell the main points
Listen and copy .
<b>Period 23 lesson 3: </b>
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbook , cassette , chalk , board ,lesson plan.</b>
<b>I. Organization:</b>
<b>II. Checking up : Asks sme Ss to stand up and say about the new word of last lesson.</b>
T corrects and give them marks
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
***
I/
1.
***
2.
II/
1.
2.
III/
<b>I / Warm up : Pelmanism</b>
run ran fly flew ride rode
eat ate sit sat come came
- Continue until all the cards are finished .
<b> Pre - listening : Introduce the topic of the listening task</b>
1. Pre – teach vocabulary :
- Foolish (a) = ngÊ ngÈn , ngèc nghiÕch
- greedy ( a) = tham lam
- Gold (n) ( realia )
- to lay -> laid – laid ( Picture )
- amazement (n) = ngạc nhiên , vui nhộn
<b>* Checking : What and where </b>
2. Prediction :
- Ask Ss to predict the moral lesson of the story .
- Have them look at four titles and guess which is the
most suitable to the story .
- Call on some Ss to read their predictions and write
them on the board .
<b> While - listening : </b>
1. Checking the prediction
- Turn on the tape twice and ask them to check their
predictions .
- Call on some Ss to read their results and give feed back
: “ Don,<sub>t be foolish and greedy “</sub>
- Turn on the tape once more to check their results
again .
2. Find out the verbs in the story :
- Ask Ss what tense is used in the story ( Simple past
tense )
- Have Ss listen again and try to write as many verbs as
possible . The student who writes more verbs get good
marks .
- Call on some Ss to read the verbs aloud .
<i>- Give feedback: went / discovered / laid / shouted / </i>
<i>finished / could not / were / ran / looked / wanted / </i>
<i>decided .</i>
- Ask Ss to give the infinitives of these verbs.
<i><b>Post - listening : Mapped dialogue</b></i>
Lan : ...lunch ?
Nga : No . I ate noodles .
Lan : How ... school ?
Nga : I rode a bicycle to school .
Lan : Which subject did you have yesterday ?
Nga : ... math .
Lan : ...?
Nga : I was at home .
- Ask them to work in pairs to practice the dialogue .
- Call on some pairs to practice in front of class .
- Correct and give feedback .
<b>Consolidations: </b>
Play game
Listen and copy
Listen and repeat in
chorus , individually
Copy down
Play game
Work in groups to
predict .
Read their predictions
aloud .
Listen to the tape and
check their predictions
Read their results and
write down .
Listen and find out the
verbs in the tape
Read them aloud .
Give the infinitives of
these verbs .
Practice in pairs
IV/
V/
- Retell the mains points.( some Ss to retell ) .
<b>V / Homework : </b>
1. Copy the completed dialogue in their notebooks .
2. Do exercises ... in workbook .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
Listen and copy .
<b>Period 24 </b>
<b>I. Teaching points :By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to understand and retell the story</b>
- The lost shoe .
<b>II. Teaching aids : Text book , word cards for drilling , cassette ,lesson plan and picture...</b>
<b>I. Organization: Greeting </b>
<b>II. Checking up: -Retell the Story “ Don’t be foolish and greedy” .</b>
- T. corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>* Warm up : * Brainstorming</b>
Name some folks tales that you have read .
Possible answers :
- Cây tre trăm đốt ( one hundred-section bamboo )
- Tấm cám . / Hồng tử Cóc ( The frog Prince )
- Đôi hài 7 dặm ( Seven mile shoes )
- Bạch tuyết và bảy chú lïn ( Snow white and 7 dwarfs )
<b>I / Pre - reading : Introduce the topic of the passage </b>
reading and some new words to Ss .
1. Pre – teach vocabulary :
- cruel (a) = độc ác , ác nghiệt
Play games in two
Copy some names of the
stories in English .
Listen and copy
<b>2.</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>3.</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
- upset (a) = worried
- fairy (n) = truỵện cổ tích
- magical (a) -> magically (adv)
- rag (n) ( realia )
- to fall in love with = yªu
- immediately (adv ) = ngay lËp tøc
<b>* Checking : R& R</b>
- Ask Ss to work in groups to predict
Statements Guess Key
1. Little Pea,<sub>s father is poor farmer </sub>
2. Her father got married again after his
wife died .
3. Her new mother was beautiful and nice
to her .
4. She worked hard all day .
5. She did not have new clothes to take part
in the festival .
T
T
F
T
F
- Call on some Ss to read their predictions and write
them on the board
<b>II / While - reading : </b>
1. Checking the predictions :
- Turn on the tape 2 times and ask them to look at their
text books to check their predictions and correct the
false ones .
- Sentence 3 : Her new mother was cruel to her .
- Sentence 5 : A fairy gave her beautiful clothes.
- Call on 2 Ss to read the story – Correct mistakes if
any.
2. Comprehension questions
- Ask Ss to work in pairs answering the questions
- Call on some pairs to practice asking and answering .
- Listen and give feedback
a. She was a poor farmer ,<sub>s daughter . </sub>
b. She made her do the chores all day .
c. Before the festival started , a fairy appeared and
magically changed her rags into beautiful clothes .
d. He decided to marry Little Pea because the shoe fitted
her .
e. Ss answer themselves .
- Call on some pairs to practice in front of class.
3. Gap filling : Complete the sentences with words from
the story .
- Ask Ss to work in pairs , filling the blanks with suitable
words from the story .
- Call on some Ss to read their complete sentences aloud
- Give feedback
a. farmer b. died
c. used d. marry / choose
e. clothes f. lost
<b>III / Post - reading : *Retell the story </b>
- Have Ss work in pairs , telling the story again in details
( They can look at the statements in the gap filling
exercise and add more )
- Call on some Ss to retell the story in front of class .
- Correct mistakes if any .
<b>Consolidations:</b>
- Retell the mains points.
<b> Homework : </b>
Listen and repeat in
chorus , individually .
Guess its meanings and
copy .
- Works in pairs
Play games
Work in groups
Read their predictions
Listen and check their
predictions .
Read their results and
correct the false ones .
Work in pairs to practice
asking and answering
the questions
Work in pairs to
complete the sentences
Read their complete
sentences .
Listen and copy .
Work in pairs to retell
the story in details .
Demonstrate in front of
Listen and copy .
1. Rewrite the story .
2. Do exercises in workbook .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
-
-
<b>I. Teaching points: By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to use Simple Past Tense to write</b>
a folk tale .
<b>II. Teaching aids : Text book , eleven cards , chalks , boards ,lesson plan</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting </b>
<b>II. Checking up:- Retell the story “the foolish famer and greedy wife”</b>
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>3.</b>
<b>4.</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b> Warm up : * Chatting</b>
- Ask Ss some questions about imaginary stories
1. Do you want to read imaginary stories ?
2. Name some of them
3. Which story do you like best ?
4. Have you ever read the story “ how the tigers got his
stripes “ ?
<b> Pre - writing : Introduce the aims of the writing and </b>
some new words .
1. Pre- teach vocabulary :
- wisdom ( n) : trÝ kh«n
- a stripe (n) ( realia )
- a straw ( n) ( realia )
- a servant (n) : ngời phục vụ , đầy tớ
- to graze ( picture )
- to escape : trèn tho¸t
- to light – lit – lighted ( mime )
<b>* Checking : Matching </b>
<b>A</b> <b>B</b>
1. wisdom a. trốn thoát
2. a stripe b. đờng sọc
3. a straw c. ăn cỏ , gặm cỏ
4. a servant d. trí khơn
5. graze e. rơm rạ
6. escape f . ®Çy tí
- Ask Ss to come to the board to match items on the left
with those on the right by drawing a line connecting the
story .
* Reading :
- Ask Ss to read and complete the story .
- Call on Ss to say the meanings of the verbs in the box .
- Have them work in pairs , using suitable verbs to fill in
the blanks .
- Call on them to read their answers aloud .
- Give feedback
1. appear 2. as 3. said 4. left
5. went 6. lit 7. burned 8. escaped
+ Comprehension questions :
1. where was the man ?
2. What did the buffalo do when the tiger
3. What did the tiger want to know ?
4. What did he do before going home ? Why ?
5. What did he do when he returned ?
- Call on some pairs to practice asking and answering
the questions above .
<b> While - writing : </b>
Play game
Listen and copy
Listen and repeat in
chorus , individually .
Guess its meanings and
copy
Work individually .
Read the verbs in the
box and say the
meanings of them .
Read the complete
story .
Work in pairs to practice
asking and answering
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
- Get Ss to do exercise 2 . ( Ss have to imagine to be a
man in order to write the story )
+ Notice : Change
The man -> I / His -> My
- Ask Ss to work individually , then share with their
partners and correct mistakes .
- Take some writings to correct in front of the class.
- Give suggested answers :
<b> Post - writing : * Telling the story </b>
- Divide the class into 2 teams . Team A plays the role of
the tiger . Team B plays the role of the buffalo
- Ask them to work in team , telling the story
Notice :
- Team tiger changes : a / the tiger -> I
- Team buffalo changes : a / the buffalo - > I
- Retell the main points.
<b> Homework : </b>
1. Write the story again , imagine you are :
* The tiger
* The buffalo
2. Do exercises in workbook .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
Write the story
individually .
Demonstrate in front of
class.
Play the roles of tiger
and buffalo , telling the
story .
Listen and copy .
<b>Period 27 Language focus</b>
<b>I. Teching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to use prepositions of time and </b>
Used to ( to talk about the action which always happens in the past ) and further practice in the
Past Simple Tense .
- Develop Ss’ four skills ( listening, speaking, reading, and writing.)
<b>II. Teaching aids : Text books , boards , chalk,posters, pictures, lesson pan.</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up :</b>
III. New lesson :
*** <b> Warm up : </b>
I/
1.
2.
II/
**
A B Key
1. In a. January 1.a / d
2. On b. 3 p m 2. c / e
3.At c. Wednesday 3. b / f
4. Between d. November 1997 4. f
5. After / Before e. July 2nd <sub>5. b</sub>
f. 7 a m and 9 am
- Call on some Ss to read aloud each phrase .
- Explain the uses of some prepositions of time and ask
Ss to do Exercises
<b>Practice </b>
Ex 3 / page 44
- Ask Ss to work individually , then compare with their
partners .
- Call on some Ss to read their complete sentences aloud
- Give feedback
<i>a. on b. in c. between d. at / after e. before</i>
<b> Ex 4 : Complete the dialogue : </b>
- Have Ss work in pairs , looking at 4 verbs , using
USED TO with the verbs “ Live – Stay – Have – be
<i>0. used to stay </i>
<i>1. used to have </i>
<i>2. used to be </i>
<i>3. used to live </i>
<b> Further practice : </b>
<b> Deliberate mistakes </b>
- Read aloud some sentences and ask Ss to listen
carefully and try to find out the mistake . When they
hear a mistake , they stand up and say No then correct
it .
Eg : T : I usually stay at home in Sunday
Ss : No , on Sunday , not in Sunday .
a. My father used to play football when he has spare
time .
b. She used live in Ha noi .
c. My parents will arrive in 3 o,<sub>lock .</sub>
d. He was born in June the third .
<b>Exercice: Complete the following sentences :</b>
0. He / used to / go / work / bicycle.
<i> =>He used to go to work by bicycle.</i>
1. When / I ./ little girl / I / not / use to / cry.
<i>=> When I was alitle girl I did not use to cry.</i>
2. My parents / used to / take / me / my sister / beautiful
<i>park / city/ Sundays. => My parents used to take me and</i>
<i>my sister to a beautiful park in the city on Sundays .</i>
3. I / used to / chase(duoi bat)/ butterflies / my / sister .
<i>=> I used to chase butterflies with my sister.</i>
4. Now / we / not / small children / any longer.
<i> => Now we are not small children any longer.</i>
5. We / teachers / secondary school / village.
<i>=> We are teachers of a secondary school in a village.</i>
<i>6. We / take / parents / beautiful park / weekends. =>We </i>
<i>take our parents to a beautiful park at the weekends.</i>
7. We / watch / stars / sky / night .
Play game
Read the correct phrases
Work individually
.Compare with their
partners .
Read the complete
sentences aloud .
Copy down .
Work in pairs
Practice the dialogue .
Play game
( Whole class )
Listen and copy .
-
- Do exercises.
works in pairs.
- Then one by one
to go to the board
to do exercises.
- copy down on
their notebook.
III/
IV/
<i>=>We watch stars in the sky at night.</i>
8. Now / They / old / can’t work.
<i>=> Now they are old and can t work.</i>’
9. We / think / must / try / please / parents / make /
<i>happy. => We think we must try to please our parents </i>
<i>and make them happy.</i>
10. We / work / support / them / make / them /
<i>comfortable. => We work to support them and to make </i>
<i>them comfortable.</i>
<b>* Consolidation :</b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson .
<b> Homework : </b>
1. Do exercises (1,2) in textbook .
2. Do the exercises in workbook .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
- Retell the main points.
- Copy down
homeworks
<b>Period 28 Lesson 1: </b>
<b>I. Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to understand the dialogue </b>
between Jim and his Mom about his study .
<b>II. Teaching aids : Text books , cassette , chalks,CD, lesson plan ..</b>
I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance
II. Checking up:
- Asks Ss to retell the mains structure grammar.
- T corrects and give them marks.
III. New lesson :
***
***
I/
1.
<b> Warm up : ** Net work </b>
- Ask Ss to write as many subjects as they can on the
blackboard
* Possible answers :
Chemistry / Physics / maths / geography / literature /
history .
- Lead in the new lesson by Chatting
<b>Pre - reading : </b>
- What subjects are you good at ? / bad at ?
- What subject do you like best ? / Why ?
- How often do you have maths ? / Literature..?
1. Pre- teach vocabulary :
- a report card ( realia ): phieu bao diem
- pronunciation ( mime ) (n) cach phat am, ngu am.
-(to)improve ( situation ):cai thien ,trau doi
-(to)be proud of = tu hao .
Work in groups to play
games
Read the answers aloud.
Chat the questions .
Listen and repeat in
chorus , individually .
Copy down
2.
II/
***
III/
IV/
- (to) promise: hua.
- to try one,<sub>s best = co gang het suc </sub>
<b>* Checking : Rub out and remember </b>
<b>* / F statements predictions : - Ask Ss to read the </b>
<b>statements and predict they are true or false .</b>
Statements Guess Key
1. Tim was out when his mother
called him . F
2. Tim,<sub>s mother met his teacher at </sub>
school . F
3. Tim,<sub>s report is poor .</sub> <sub>F</sub>
4. Tim needs to improve his Spanish
grammar T
5. Tim promised to try his best in
learning Spanish . T
- Call on some Ss to read their predictions and write
them on the board .
<b> While - reading : </b>
- Turn on the tape and ask Ss to look at their books , then
read the dialogue to check their predictions .
- Call on some Ss to read their results .
- Give feedback :
- Ask Ss to correct false statements .
3. He needs to improve his Spanish pronunciation .
- Call on some pairs to practice the dialogue in front of
class .
- Listen and correct their pronunciation if any .
* Comprehension questions :
- Ask Ss to work in pairs , answering the questions .
- Call on some pairs to practice asking and answering
the questions .
- Give feedback .
a. She is Tim,<sub>s teacher . </sub>
b. She gave Tim,<sub>s mother his report card . </sub>
c. He worked really hard .
d. She said Tim should work harder on his Spanish
pronunciation .
e. She gave him a dictionary
- Ask them to practice in open pairs .
<b>Post - reading : Survey </b>
- Ask Ss to work in groups by standing to ask each other
Name What subject
Lan
…………. History ………..
- Ask Ss who need to improve the same subjects work in
group and discuss how to improve .
<b> Homework : 1. Write the way how to improve the </b>
subject that they are not good at .
2. Prepare the next lesson .
Work individually
Read their predictions
aloud .
Listen and read the
dialogue to check their
predictions .
Correct false ones .
Work in pairs to practice
asking and answering
the questions .
Open pairs
- Asks each other: What
subjects do you need to
improve ?
Work in groups
Listen and copy .
-Copy down homeworks
<b>Period 29 lesson 2: </b>
<b>I. Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to talk about their study habits .</b>
- Develop Ss’ speaking skill.
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbooks , cassette , chalks , poster, lesson plan, CD.</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up : - Asks Ss retell sme mains subjects at school.</b>
- Some pairs ask and answer about their subjects
<b>S1: How often do we have music ?</b>
<b>S2: We have music 2times aweek.</b>
=> T corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson :</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b> Warm up : </b>
<b>*Brainstorming</b>
- Ask Ss to write their ideas on the blackboard .
* Possible answers :
- Speak English to friends in class
- Watch English TV
- Do grammar exercises
- Read English stories
- Read English newspapers / magazines
- Listen to the English radio program
<b>Pre - speaking : </b>
Introduce the topic of the speaking .
- Call on some Ss to read the possible answers above
and copy down .
- Have Ss read the questions and words in the boxes.
<b> While </b>–<b> speaking : </b>
- Asks Ss work in groups of three or four .in the tables.
Ask each other about your studies.Use the questions and
words in the boxes to help them.
1. When do you do your homework?
Work in groups to play
games .
Read all the ways of
improving English .
Copy in their
notebooks .
Listen and read the
model , then copy
Work in pairs
Practice in front of class.
Work individually .
Read their writings
<b>How to improve </b>
<b>your English ?</b>
<b>How to improve </b>
<b>your English ?</b>
Do Exercises Read EL stories
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
( after school / after dinner / late at night / … )
2. Who helps you with your homework?
( your parents / your brother / your sisters / a friend …)
..
…
- Asks Ss do exercises in the text books in page 48 .
- T gets feedback.
Call some pairs to talk loudly.
- Others listening.
<b>* Model : </b>
<i><b> Lan said she did her homework after dinner</b></i>
<i><b> He / she said ………</b></i>
- Call on some pairs to read the model
- Ask Ss to work in pairs .
- Call on some pairs to practice in front of class.
<b>- Correct mistakes if any . </b>
<b>Post - speaking : </b>
- Ask Ss to write with information above .
Eg : Lan ,<sub>s elder brother helps him with his homework . </sub>
- Call on some Ss to read their writings .
<b>Consolidation: </b>
-Retell the mains points of this lesson .( Some Ss to
retell)
<b> Homework : </b>
1. Copy the effective ways of learning English they have
found out .
2. Do exercises in workbook .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
- Ss works in pairs .
- copy down some keys
if necessary.
- Write with these
informations
- Some pairs to
practise.
- Retell the main points .
Copy down
homeworks..
<b> Period 30 unit 5 :Study habits</b>
<b>lesson 3 : Listen + LanGuage focus 1.</b>
A / <b> The aims :</b>
<b>I. Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to listen for specific </b>
information to fill in a report card . And They will be able to use adverb of manner, do
exercises language focus 1+ 2 in page 52 in Ss’s books.
<b>II.Teaching aids : Textbooks , cassette , chalks , lesson plan, posters.</b>
<b>B/ Steps of the lesson :</b>
<b>I. Organizations : - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up : - Asks Ss retell the new words of last lesson.</b>
- T . corrects and give them marks.
III . New lesson :
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b> Warm up : * Retelling </b>
- Ask Ss to retell “ How to improve your English “
<b> Pre - listening : Introduce the topic of the listening </b>
and some new words :
Pre – teach vocabulary :
- behavior (n) = cach ung xu, hanh vi. (trans..)
- participant (n) = nguoi tham gia, su tham gia.
- Satisfactory >< unsatisfactory (adj)
thoa mai, hai long, toai nguyen > < ko thoa mai,…
- cooperation (n) = su hop tac
- attendance (n) = su du, so nguoi co mat,
- (to)appreciate = danh gia cao ,cam kich, hieu ro
gia tri.
<b>* Checking : What and where </b>
Prediction :
Retell individually .
Listen and copy .
Listen and repeat in
chorus and
individually .
Copy down .
Play game
<b>II/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
- Ask Ss to look at Nga,<sub>s report and predict the </sub>
missing information and then compare with their
partners .
<b>a. day present (1) / b. Day absent (2) </b>
<b>c. Behavior – participant (3)</b>
<b>d. Listening (4) / e. Speaking (5)</b>
<b>f. Reading (6) / g. Writing (7)</b>
- Call on some Ss to read their predictions and write
them on the board .
<b>While - listening :</b>
1. Listen :
- Get Ss to listen to the tape and check their
prediction .
- Call on Ss to read their results and give feedback .
2. 5 days absent
3. participation : Spanish pronunciation
4. Listening : Comprehension
5. Speaking : A
6 . Reading : A 7 . Writing : B
<b>Comprehension questions : </b>
- Ask Ss to answer some questions about Nga,<sub>s </sub>
report card .
1. Who are Nga,<sub>s parents ?</sub>
2. What is Nga,<sub>s teacher</sub>,<sub>s name ? </sub>
3. What subject was reported ? For what term ?
4. What are the comments ?
5. What does S stand for ? What about F UA B CD ?
- Ask Ss to listen to the tape again and work in pairs
to answer the questions .
- Call on some pairs to practice in front of class .
- Give feedback .
<b> Post - listening : </b>
<b> ** Survey:</b>
Questions You ur
partner
1. When do you do your
homework ?
2. Who helps you with your
homework?
3. How much time do you spend
on Maths / English / History /
Literature ?
4. Which subject do you need to
improve ?
5. What do you do to improve
your English?
- Ask Ss to work in pairs , asking their partners
questions and taking notes of the answers .
- Ask Ss to work in groups of 4 0r 5 to report what
they have known about their partners,<sub> study . </sub>
- Correct mistakes if any .
<b>Language focus !+ 2 (52)</b>
<b>1. Complete the dialoguge: - T hangs a poster</b>
Predict and compare
with their partners .
Report their
predictions .
Listen to the tape and
check their predictions
Read their results .
Work in pairs tom
practice asking and
answering the
questions .
Practice asking and
answering the
questions and report
their survey .
- Do exercises LF
1 , Works in
pairs.
– Asks Ss to do exercises in pairs .
<b> 2. Look at the picture and say what he </b>
<b>should do</b>
<b>Eg: Mr. Hao should repair the roof.</b>
…
<b>Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the mains points of this lesson .
<b> Homework : </b>
1. Write something about your partners,<sub> study habits</sub>
Eg : Lan is my best friend . She works very hard and
always get good grades . she usually does her
homework after school
Listen and copy down
homeworks.
<b>Period 31:</b>
<b>I . Teachingpints : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to understand the text and get </b>
specific information ..
- They can do all exercises language focus 3,4 in the textbooks (52).
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbooks , cassette , chalks, lesson plans,posters….</b>
<b>I. Organizations: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up : - Asks 2Ss to go to the board to read the dialoguge .</b>
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I /</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>Warm up : * Chatting </b>
1. Do you like English ?
2. How many new words do you try to learn a day ?
3. What do you do when you read a new words ?
- Correct and lead in the new lesson .
<b>Pre - reading : Introduce the topic of the reading </b>
passage and some new words .
Pre- teach vocabulary :
-(a) Mother tongue ( example ): tiếng mẹ đẻ
-(to )underline ( example ): gạch dới, gạch chân.
- (to) highlight ( example ):làm nổi bật.
-( to) come across ( synonym ) = Run in to : gặp tình cờ.
- (to) stick ( mime ): dán , dÝnh , cµi…
<b>* Checking : * Slap the board </b>
Brainstorming
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to make a list of the ways how
a language learner can learn new words .
Practice asking and
answering the question
Listen and copy .
Listen and repeat in
Play games
Work in pairs
Page 53 School year : 2010- 2011
<b>Ways language learners </b>
<b>***</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>III./</b>
<b>IV /</b>
<b>V/</b>
* Possible answers :
- Learn by heart
- Translate it into mother tongue
- Write each word on one piece of paper and put it into
the pocket to learn whenever
- Learn through example sentences
- Write it on small piece of paper and stick everywhere
in the house …….
<b>While - reading : </b>
1. True / False statements
- Ask Ss to read the statements , then read the text and
decide which is true and which is false .
( Page 50 )
- Call on Ss to read their answers and give feedback
a. F b. T c . F d . T
* Reading :
- Call on 2 or 3 Ss to read the passage aloud .
2. Comprehension questions
- Have Ss work in pairs to answer the questions
- Call on some Pairs to practice asking and answering
the questions
- Give feedback
a. No . They learn words in different ways .
b. Because they help them to remember the use of new
c. They write examples , put the words and their
meanings on stickers , underline or highlight them .
d. They may think they can not do so . Instead , they
learn only important words .
e. Revision is necessary in learning words .
f. Learners should try different ways of learning words t
find out what is the best .
<b>Post - reading : * Survey </b>
- Ask Ss to work in groups to interview one another and
tick the ways they have used to learn new words
<b>Ways of learning words </b> <b>Lan </b> <b>Hoa</b> <b>...</b>
1. Make a list of words , their meanings
and learn them by heart .
2. Write sample sentences with new words
3. Stick new words somewhere in the
house .
4. Underline or highlight the words .
5. Read stories in English .
6. Learn words through songs .
- Call on Ss to report about their groups .
Ex : Lan learns words by making a list of words ….
<b>Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main points ß thÝ leson .
<b> Homework : </b>
1. Write the ways of learning words that you think are
the best for you .
2. Prepare the next lesson .
Report and copy the
answers .
Work individually
Read the text aloud .
Practice asking and
answering the questions
in pairs .
Work in groups .
Copy down homeworks
<b>Period 32 Lesson 5 : </b>
<b>I. Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to know the format of a friendly</b>
letter and practice writing a letter to a friend .
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbook , chalks , boards,lesson plan, posters ….</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance </b>
<b>II. Checking up: -Asks 2 Ss to go to the board to retell the new words and meaning of these </b>
words. Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>3.</b>
<b>4.</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b> Warm up : Chatting </b>
1. Have you ever written to someone ?
2. To whom do you usually write ?
3. What do you often write about ?
- Lead in new lesson .
<b> Pre - writing : Introduce the topic of the writing and </b>
some new words to Ss .
Pre – teach vocabulary :
- Lunar New Year Festival ( explanation )Tet am lich.
- Enjoyable (adj ) = vui thu , thich thu, vui thich
- (to) celebrate = ki niem , to chuc ki niem.
-> celebration (n) le ki niem.
- Mid-Autumn Festival(n) Tet trung thu.
- Moon festival( n) : le hoi mung trang
<b>* Checking : Rub out and remember </b>
<b> Ordering: </b>
- Ask Ss to put the parts of the letter in the correct order.
a. Opening d. Body of the letter
b. Closing e. Signature
c. The date f . Writer,<sub>s address .</sub>
- Give feedback 1-f 2-c 3-a 4-d 5-b 6-e
- Ask Ss to read the letter to check their order .
<b> Labeling </b>
- Ask Ss to label each section with the correct letter .
<b>Comprehension questions </b>
- Have Ss work in pairs and answer some questions
a. Who wrote the letter ? To whom ?
b. What are there in the heading ?
c. What is the main part of the letter ?
d. What did Hoa receive a few days ago ?
e. What subject is Hoa good at ?
f. Where is she going to celebrate the Lunar New Year
Festival ?
- Call on some pairs to practice asking and answering in
front of class .
<b>While - writing : </b>
- Ask Ss to imagine that they are Lan and write a letter
to her pen pal Donna in San Francisco , using the given
information .
- Call on some Ss to demonstrate their writings in front
of class .
* Suggested letter :
Play games
Listen and copy down
Listen and repeat in
chorus , individually .
Copy down .
Play games .
Do the exercise
individually .
Read and check .
Label each section with
the correct letter .
Work in pairs to practice
asking and answering
the questions .
Imagine and write the a
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
<i>15 Quang Trung street </i>
<i>Hanoi , July 12 th , 2005 </i>
<i>Dear Donna </i>
<i>Thanks for your letter . I am glad to hear you had an </i>
<i>interesting Mother,<sub>s Day .</sub></i>
<i>We have received our second semester report last </i>
<i>month . I got good grades for Geography , Physics and </i>
<i>Math but my English and History results were poor . My</i>
<i>teacher advises me to improve English and History . I </i>
<i>think I have to study harder next school year . </i>
<i>In a few weeks , we are going to celebrate the mid </i>
<i>Autumn festival . That is an Autumn moon festival in </i>
<i>Vietnam . This afternoon , I am going to Ha Long Bay </i>
<i>with my aunt and uncle by bus and I am going to stay </i>
<i>ther with them until the festival comes . I will send you a</i>
<i>postcard from there . </i>
<i>Write soon and tell me all your news . </i>
<i>Best </i>
<i>Lan , </i>
<b> Post - writing : ***Correction </b>
- Call on Ss to read aloud their letters and correct the
mistakes .
<b>Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson .
<b>Homeworks : </b>
1. Write a letter to your friend to tell him / her about
your second semester report and about Summer
holiday .
2. Learn by heart vocabulary and mains structure
grammar.
3. Redo all exercises of language focus .
4. Prepare for next lesson.
letter individually .
- Share with their
partners
Read their letters aloud .
Copy down .
- Retell the mains points
of this lesson.
- Copy dowm
homeworks
<b>Period 33: </b>
<b>I. Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to use adverbs of manner and </b>
modal Should as an advice , reported speech with commands , requests and advice .
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbook , poster , ten cards, lesson plan .</b>
<b>I. Organization : - Greeting and checking attendance </b>
<b>II. Checking up: - T asks some questions and call some Ss to answer the qs:</b>
1. Do you often write to someone? ( yes, I do)
2. Who do you often wrtie to?( I often wrtie to my friends)
3. What do you often include in your letter ?( Inlcude : heading, open, body of the letter,
closing )
4. How do you open a letter?( Dear, …)
5. How do you close it ? ( Your friend / Regards / Love …).
=> T gets feedback and give them marks .
Page 57 School year : 2010- 2011
<b>I /</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>3.</b>
rode eat ate sit sat
- Explain the meanings and uses of them
+ Hard (a) and hard ( adv ) have different meanings
<b> Presentation </b>
<b>Adverbs of manner .</b>
- Setting the scene “ Use any word from the game
Pelmanism to complete the following sentences “
* Form : S + V + a / an + adjective + noun
or : S + be + Adjective
S + V + adverb
* Use : Adj modifies the noun after it / the subject
<i>Exercise 1 / 52 : Complete the dialogues </i>
- Ask Ss to work in pairs .
- Call on some pairs to demonstrate in front of class
- Give feedback .
<i>1. hard 2. fast 3. badly 4. softly</i>
- Ask ss to practice the dialogue in open pairs .
<b> Modal : Should </b>
- Ask Ss to look at Mr Hao,<sub>s house and answer some </sub>
questions
a. Is his house new ?
b. Is the wall discolored ?
c. How is the door ?
d. Is there grass in his garden ?
e. Should Mr Hao repair the roof ?
Suggested answers :
a. No , it isn,<sub>t b. Yes , it is c. It is broken </sub>
d. Yes. There is lots of grass in his garden.
e. Yes, he should .
-> Explain the modal “ Should “
+ Form : S + Should + infinitive
+ Use : give advice
+ Meaning : nen ( lam gi )
<i>Exercise 2 / 52 </i>
Give Ss the question “ What should he do with his house
?
mend ? / paint ? / replant ? / cut ? / repair ?
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to use the verbs to advise Mr
Hao what to do .
- Call on some pairs to practice asking and answering
the question “ What should he do with his house ? “
- Give feedback .
a. Mr Hao should repair the roof .
b…………...paint the house
c. ………...cut the grass .
d. ………...replant the tree
e. ………….mend the door
<b>Commands , requests in reported speech </b>
- Explain the form of the reported speech :
* Form :
<b>To ask / tell + someone + to do something </b>
+ Example :
a. “ Can you give Tim this dictionary ? “
=> Mr Jackson asked me to give you this dictionary
b. “ Please give Tim this dictionary . “
=> Miss Jackson told me to give you this dictionary
<i>Exercise 3 / 53 : Explain the situation to Ss </i>
- Have Ss work in pairs to do exercise .
- Call on some pairs to read their answers aloud , then go
to the board to write them on .
- Give feedback
a. Miss Jackson asked me to wait for her outside her
office .
Listen and copy down
Work in pairs
Demonstrate in front of
class .
Practice asking and
Listen and give
examples .
Practice in pairs
Practice in pairs in front
of class .
<b>Period 34 lesson 1</b>
<b> I . Teaching points: By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to understand the dialogue </b>
about the young pioneers .Ss Will be able to use the simple present tense with future meaning.
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbook , 5 cards for drill , Cassette, posters, lesson plan.</b>
<b>I. Organization: Greeting and checking attendance .</b>
<b>II. Checking up:Asks 2 Ss to retell the new words and their meaning .</b>
<b>III. New lwesson :</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>3.</b>
<b>* Warm up : * Chatting </b>
Ask Ss some questions about their activities and their summer
holidays .
1. What do you often do on your summer holiday ?
2. Are you members of the Young Pioneers and Youth
Organization ?
3. Are there any activity programs for the summer ?
4. Do you take part in them ?
5. What activity do you like most ?
<b> Presentation : Introduce the topic of the lesson and some new </b>
. Pre – teach vocabulary :
-( to ) enroll ( translation ) :dang ki vao., ghi danh.
- Answer application form ( visual )
- Out door activities : Games that you play in the open air rather
than in a building or a house such as : football , tennis ….
- Hobby (n) (Revision)
- Acting (n) (revision)
<b>* Checking :* Rub out and remember </b>
Listen and read the dialogue :
- Set the scene “ Nga is a student in grade eight . She wants to
enroll in the activities for the summer . “
- Ask Ss to listen and read the dialogue at the same time.
- Get Ss to work in pairs and complete Nga,<sub>s particulars . </sub>
- Call on some pairs to demonstrate in front of class.
- Give feedback
* Name : Pham Thi Nga
* Home address : 5 Tran Phu Street
* Phone number : Not available
* Date of birth : April 22 , 1989
* Interest : Drawing , outdoor , activities , acting
- Ask Ss answer some questions :
+ What is her name ?
+ What does she live ?
+ When was she born ?
+ What are her hobbies ?
Chatting
( whole class )
Listen and repeat
in chorus and
individually ,
then copy .
Play game
Listen to the tape
Read the
dialogue
<b>***</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
- Call on some Ss to answer the questions .
. Concept checking
- What is after “ likes “ ? -> drawing
- What is after “ enjoys “ ? -> acting
- What do you call “ drawing “ and “ acting “ -> gerund
- What is the form of “ gerund “ ? -> V- ing
- When do we use “ gerund “ ? - > after some verbs : like ,
love , enjoy , hate , mind .
<b> * Form Like , love , enjoy , hate + gerund</b>
* Drill : word cue drill
- Prepare 5 cards with these cues on them :
a. play soccer / volley ball
b. watch TV / listen to music
c. read books / do homework
d. Chat with friends / do the housework
e. Cook meal / decorate the house .
=> What are your hobbies ?
* I like / love playing soccer and volleyball .
- Call on Ss to practice asking and answering
- Correct mistakes if any .
- Call on some pairs to practice the dialogue .
<b>Production * Survey </b>
- Ask Ss to copy down the chart and work in groups of three
to ask their friends and tick on the chart .
Do you like name / Nam Mai
love like don,<sub>t</sub>
hate like love like don
,<sub>t</sub>
hate like
- play soccer
- washing up
- cooking meals
- performing music
- gathering broken
glasses
- watching TV
- play badminton
- Give feedback by asking Ss to report their friends,
hobbies .
<b>Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b> Homework : </b>
1. Write about their friend,<sub>s hobbies . </sub>
- Learn vocabulary, main structure Grammar by heart
2. Prepare the next lesson .
Answer the
questions
( whole class )
Listen and copy
the form . Then
practice
Practice reading
the dialogue in
pairs .
Work in groups
-Ss Retell the
main points.
<b>Period 35: Lesson 2</b>
<b>I. Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to ask for favors and respond to </b>
favors . offer and respond to assistance .
Develop Ss’ speaking skill.
<b>II. Teaching aids: Cut out shark , cut out girl / boy , textbook , lesson plan,posters.</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendances</b>
<b>II. Checking up: - Retell the model sentences.</b>
Two Others to go to the board to read again dialouge.
-Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>Warm up : * Shark,<sub> s attack </sub></b>
- Cut out a shark and a school girl / boy from card
- Draw some steps , then stick the cut out girl / boy on
the top of the steps , the sharks in the sea .
- Draw 5 gaps for the word – favor
<b>Presentation </b>
- Ask Ss the meanings of the word FAVOR
+ What do you say to ask for a favor ?
Can you help me ?
Could you do me a favor ?
Can / Could you ………..?
+ When do you ask for favor ?
Need some help
+ How do you say to respond to favor ?
Certainly / Of course / sure
No problem
+ What does the receptionist say ?
May I help you ?
+ What is for ?
For offering assistance
+ another way to offer assistance ?
Do you need any help ? / Let me help you .
+ How do you say to respond to assistance ?
Yes . No , thank you .
- Ask Ss to copy down the following phrases
<b>Asking for favor</b> <b>Responding for favor</b>
* Can / Could you help
me please ?
* Could you do me a
favor ?
* I need a favor
* Can / could you ..?
* Certainly / of course / sure
* No problem
* What can I do for you ?
<b>Offering assistance </b> <b>Responding to assistance </b>
* May I help you ?
* Do you need any help
?
* Let me help you .
* Yes / No . Thank you
* Yes . That is very kind of you .
* No . thank you . I am fine .
I can manage .
- Ask Ss to repeat chorally and then individually all the
phrases in the chart .
<b> Practice : </b>
* Ss to work in pairs to practice the dialogues
- Call on some pairs to practice in front of class .
- Correct pronunciation if any .
* Use the appropriate phrases to make similar
dialogues about some of the following situations with a
Play game in two teams
Listen and practice
asking and answering
the questions
-Work in pairs.
Listen and copy
-Work individually
- Practice in pairs
- Copy down on their
notebooks
-Work individually
Repeat chorally ,
individually
-Practice the dialogue.
Work in pairs
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
partner.
- Have Ss work in pairs .
- Call on some pairs to practice in front of class .
- Give feedback
<b> Production : Situation : A receptionist wants to help a </b>
tourist who needs to go to the nearest bank
<b>Receptionist : ………?</b>
<b>Tourist : yes . Can you ………..?</b>
<b>Receptionist : Sure . Turn right when you get out of </b>
the hotel . Turn left at the first corner .
………... your right .
<b>Tourist :………</b>
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to make the dialogue and move
around the class and help Ss .
- Call on some Ss to practice the dialogue in front of the
class .
<b>Consolidations: </b>
-Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>Homework : </b>
1. Learn by heart the expressions to offer assistance and
favor and how to respond them .
2. Write the dialogue between you and a tourist who lost
money .
- Prepare for next lesson.
dialogues.
Work in pairs
Closed pairs
- Move around the class
and to make the
dialogues.
Practice the dialogues in
front of class
Listen and copy .
- Copy down
homeworks
<b>Period 36</b>
<b>lesson 3</b>
<b> I. Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to complete a song for </b>
details
<i><b>II.Teaching aids : Text book , cassette , chalk , posters , lesson plan.</b></i>
<b>I . Organization: </b>
-Greeting and checking attendance.
<b>II. Checking up :</b>
Asks 2 Ss to go to the board to read aloud their letter.
-Teacher corrects and give them marks .
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>Warm up : Listen to a song </b>
- Let Ss listen to the song for fun
<b> Pre - listening : Introduce the topic of the listening </b>
and some new words to Ss .
*Pre – teach vocabulary
Listen to a song
<b>2.</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>a)</b>
<b>b)</b>
- to unite = doan ket , hop nhat , ket hop ( trans)
- peace (n) > < war (n)
- (to) shout out (st) : noi to (action)
- hold hand (v) : nam tay. (action)
- … From place to place …: tu noi nay den noi
khac…
+ Land: (revision)
<b>* Guess the missing words </b>
- Ask Ss to guess the words to fill in the gaps in the
song
- Get them to share with their partners and report
their predictions .Then write them on the board .
<b> While - listening : </b>
- Turn on the tape 3 times and ask Ss to check their
predictions .
- Call on some Ss to read their results
- Give feedback
<i><b>Children of our land unite </b></i>
<i>Let,<b><sub>s sing for peace , </sub></b></i>
<i>Let,<b><sub>s sing for right .</sub></b></i>
<i>Let,<b><sub>s sing for the love between north and south , </sub></b></i>
<i><b>Oh, children of our land , unite .</b></i>
<i><b>Children of the world hold hands .</b></i>
<i>Let,<b><sub>s show our love from place to place .</sub></b></i>
<i>Let,<b><sub>s shout out loud ,</sub></b></i>
<i>Let,<b><sub>s make a stand ,</sub></b></i>
<i><b>Oh , children of the world , hold hands . </b></i>
-Turn on the tape once more to check the results
again .
<b> Post - listening : </b>
- Ask Ss to work in groups to learn how to sing the
song
+ Ss listen to the tape and repeat in chorally .
- Call on some Ss from each groups to sing a song.
<b>* Language focus 2:</b>
<b>+ Gerunds: (danh dong tu) We use the _ing form </b>
as a noun called a gerund.
+ The gerund as an uncountable noun in general
statements.
eg: Dancing is fun.
+ The gerund as an uncountablenoun with SOME,
ANY , NO , A LOT OF, ALITTLE , ENOUGH.
eg: I did some shopping this morning . …
*Look at the table . Talk about our friends’ hobbies:
A: Ba loves playing soccer , but he doesn’t like
washing up.
B: Lan doesn’t like playing soccer and she doesn’t
like washing up ,either.
<b>…..</b>
Listen and copy down
Work in groups to
guess the missing
words in the song .
Report their
predictions.
Listen to the tape and
check their predictions
Read their answers .
Listen and check the
results again .
Learn how to sing
Listen and copy .
Work in groups of
four.
- Some Ss of each
group to sing a song.
- Copy down new
Grammar
Structure .
-Work individually.
Give example.
- Look at the
table and talk
about their
friends’ hobbies.
- Work in pairs .
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
* Copy the table in to your exercise book.Then
complete it with information about you . Next ask
and answer questions with your partner.:
<i>A - Do you like playing soccer ? </i>
<i>B - No. I hate it . What about you ?.</i>
<b>* Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>Homework : </b>
1. Copy down the completed song .
2. Prepare the next lesson .
-Then ask and answer
the questions with
your partner .
Some Ss retell the
main points of this
lesson.
-Copy down
homeworks.
<b>Period 37 - lesson 4</b>
<b>I-Teaching points :By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to know more about a youth </b>
organization – the Boy Scouts of America ( BSA )
<b>II.Teaching aids : Text book , Poster of T /F statements , lesson plan.</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up: - Asks 2 Ss to go to the board to retell the new words .</b>
- The whole class sing a song of last lesson.
<b>III. New lesson: </b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>*Warm up : *Jumbled words </b>
- Write six words whose letters are in disorder
1. Racchtaer 4. Pexainl
2. Iojn 5 . Nessmsibuan
3. Mai 6 . Thauolgh
- Ask Ss to work in 2 teams and call on 6 Ss from h team
write the right words on the board .
1. Character 2. Join 3. Aim
4. Explain 5. Businessman 6. Although
<b>*Pre- reading : Introduce the topic of the reading </b>
passage and some new words to Ss .
1. Pre – teach vocabulary :
- to encourage : give the verb which means to give Sb
support
- Citizenship (n) = quyen cong dan
- coeducational (a) ( translation )
- Voluntary (a) = tu y , tu nguyen .
- to establish = to start / to create an organization
<b>* Checking : Slap the board </b>
*T /F Statements prediction
- Stick the poster with the statements on the blackboard
and guess which is true , which is false .
a. The Boy Scout of America is a youth organization
b. Scouting began in America
c. William Boyce is a businessman in LOndon .
d. Boys and girls can join BSA
e. The Scouting Association is the biggest voluntary
youth organization in the world .
- Call on Ss to report their predictions and write them on
the board
Work in 2teams
+ Play a game
Listen and copy .
- Work individually.
- Copy down new
lesson..
Repeat chorally ,
individually .
Play game
Work in groups to
predict .
Report their predictions
<b>2.</b>
<b>3.</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
<b>*While - reading : </b>
* Reading :
- Turn on the tape and ask Ss to look at their books at the
same time to read the passage to check their predictions
- Call on some Ss to read their results aloud and give
feedback : a. T b. F c. F d. F e. T
- Have them correct false statements .
b. Scout began in England
c. William Boysce is an American business man .
d. BSA is mainly for boys .
- Call on some Ss to read the passage aloud .
- Correct mistakes if any .
*Fill in the missing dates
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to do exercise 1 / 57
- Call on some pairs to demonstrate in front of class
- Give feedback :a.1907 b. 1909 c. 1910 d. 1994
- Have Ss work in pairs to practice asking answering the
questions .
- Call on some pairs to practice in front of the class
- Give feedback
a. Scouting began in England in 1907
b. The meeting between a boy scout and Mr William Boyce led the
Scouts Association crossing the Atlantic in 1910 .
c. Girls can join in the Girls Guides Association and Camp Fire
Boys and girls .
d. They are building characters , good citizenship and personal
fitness .
<b>*Post - reading : Interview a member of the Boys </b>
Scouts of American
- Call on an excellent student in class to practice with
the teacher .
- Ask Ss to work in closed pairs
<b>Interview</b> <b>Member of BSA</b>
1. When did scouting
2. When were the
aims established ?
3. Can a girl join the
BSA ?
4 . How many
members does the
Scouting Association
have now ?
5. Is it the largest
voluntary Youth
Organization in the
world ?
- In 1907 in England
- They were established in
1907 . They are building the
characters , good citizenship
and personal fitness .
- No , It is mainly for boys
but girls can join similar
organization such as the Girl
Guides Association or the
Coeducational Camp fire
Boys and Girls .
Over 25 million
- Yes, Of course
<b>Consolidation: - Retell the main points of this lesson .</b>
<b>*/ Homework : </b>
1. Learn by heart new words and write the summary of
the BSA.
2. Prepare the next lesson
Listen to the tape and
read the passage to
check their predictions
Read their results .
Correct the false
statements
Read the passage aloud .
Work in pairs to do the
exercise
Work in pairs to practice
asking and answering
the questions .
Work in open pairs
- Interview a member of
the BSA.
Listen and copy
- Work in group of 3 or
four
- Some Ss to retell the
main points .
- Copy down
homeworks.
<b>I. Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to write a letter about a future </b>
<i><b>plan using be going to </b></i>
<b>II.Teaching aids : Text book , chalk , board, lesson plan.</b>
<b>I. Organization: Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up: T asks some questions – call 2 Ss answer : c and d (57)</b>
<i><b>+ Keys: 1. Girls can join in the : “ The Girl guides Association </b></i>…
2. The three aims of the …..
=> Teacher corrects and give them marks.
III. New lesson:
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>3.</b>
<b>4.</b>
<b>*Warm up : Revision of the structure Be going to </b>
- Ask Ss the usage of “ be going to “ – to express a
future plan . Get Ss to make the sentence :
“ I am going to + Verb “ ( The verbs have to begin with
a letter from A to Z :
Ex: T : I am going to accept their invitation .
S1 : I am going to buy a new bicycle
S2 : I am going to clean the floor .
S3 : I am going to dust the furniture ..
<b> Pre - writing : Introduce the topic of the writing and </b>
<b>** Pre </b>–<b> teach vocabulary : </b>
- to raise fund ( translation )
- a bank ( visual )
- natural resources : coal oil , iron .. under the ground or
the sea .
<b>* Reading the notice </b>
- Ask Ss to read the notice “ To : All Y and Y members
of the school “
- Ask some questions to check their understanding
a. What do members of the Y and Y have to do in the
recycling program ?
b. What is the purpose of the recycling program ?
c. What other programs can members of the Y and Y
participate in ?
- Get Ss to work in pairs to answer the questions .
- Give feedback and ask them to practice in open pairs .
<b>* Complete the letter </b>
- Ask some questions to set the scene :
- Who writes the letter ? ( Nga )
- To whom does Nga write ? ( Linh )
- What does Nga write to Linh about ? ( She writes
about the programs of her school Y and Y that she is
going to participate )
- Get Ss to work in pairs to fill in the gaps in the letter .
- Give feedback :1. community 2.recycling 3.collect
4. send 5. recycling 6. save 7. raise / earn
8. participating 9. planting 10 . helping
- Call on some Ss to read the complete letter and correct
mistakes if any .
<b>* Reading the dialogue :Set the scene“Hoa talks to her </b>
aunt about the Y and Y Green Group, about the activities
that she is going to do .”
- Ask Ss to read the dialogue between Hoa and her aunt .
* Checking : Some questions :
a. Why does Hoa look happy ?
Play game
Listen and copy
Listen and repeat
chorally and
individually
Read the notice and
answer the questions
Practice asking and
answering the questions
in pairs
Listen and answer
( the whole )
Work in pairs to
complete the letter .
Read the complete letter
.
Listen and copy .
<b>II/</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV</b>
b. What is she going to do in the environment month ?
c.What are they doing to earn money for their school
Y & Y ?
- Call on some Ss to demonstrate their answers in front
of the class .
<b>*While - writing : </b>
- Ask Ss to help Hoa to write a letter to her parents .
- Get Ss to work in group of 4 or 5 to write a letter on
poster . Move around the class and help then if they are
necessary .
<b>*Post - writing : </b>
- Choose four letters from 4 group and stick them on the
board. Get the whole class to read the 4 letters and
correct them .
<b>- Give feedback : * Suggested letter </b>
Dear Mom and Dad ,
I am very happy to tell you that I am able to join in the
Y & Y Green Group of my school .
The green Group is holding an environment month plan .
We are going to clean the lakes,<sub>banks on weekends . We</sub>
are also going to plant trees and flowers in the parks and
water them every afternoon after class . We are planting
young trees and plants to sell to other schools . I hope
that we can bring more green to the city and earn some
I am still in a very good health . I will tell you more
about the group activities later .
With love ,
Hoa .
<b>*Homeworks:</b>
Ask each student to help Hoa write a letter to her
parents in their notebooks .
Practice asking and
answering the
questions .
Work in groups to write
the letter
Stick their letters on the
board and correct its
mistakes
Read the suggested
letter aloud
Listen and copy .
<b>I.Teaching points : By the end of the lesson, Ss will be able to practice all structure </b>
grammar from unit 3 to unit 6 .
- Develop Ss’ four skills.
<b>II. Preparation: -Text books, lesson plan, posters .</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up: </b>
-Asks Ss to retell the new words and read again the dialogue.
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
Page 67 School year : 2010- 2011
+ Một số động từ thờng đứng trớc danh động từ:
- (to) finish - (to)delay
- (to) prevent(ngăn cản) - (to)enjoy
- (to) avoid(tr¸nh) - (to) try
- (to) deny( chèi) - (to)like
- (to)dislike = don’t like = doesn’t like <b>…</b>
<b>+ Modal verbs: May / can / could .</b>
<b>* May: Dùng để chỉ sự cho phép .</b>
eg: May I use your phone?
May I go out ?
May còn dùng để diễn tả ý đề nghị giúp ngời
khác làm gì. Cách dùng này chỉ phép lịch sự
của ngời nói.
eg: May I help you?
May I carry the box for you ?
- Yes. That’s very kind of you.
<b>* Can / Could : cã thÓ </b>
- Thờng dùng để diễn tả khả năng, năng lc cú th
lm gỡ.
<b>- could là quá khứ của can.</b>
eg: He can play piano.
Can you swim ?
He can lift heavy stone (có thể nhấc hịn đá nặng).
Ngồi ra can / could cịn có thể dùng đề nghị
ai giúp đỡ mình làm việc gì.( Asking for
favors )
eg: Could you help me , please ?
- Could you do me a favor?
- Can you lift the box for me, please ?
=> We use simple present tense to express an action
that happens in the future .
- Ask Ss to practice asking and answering about the
Y&Y activity by using the cues in the books.
<b>Use gerund or infinitive:</b>
1. I can’t help (feel) . anxious ( lo âu, băn
khoăn) about her study.
2. He likes ( begin) ……. knitting ( c«ng viƯc
®an len) but hates ( finish) …… it .
3. He loves ( swim) …. in the early morning.
4. Why do you watch the milk (boil) … over ?
5. Most people prefer ( ride) … to ( walk) … .
6. She has stopped ( drink) … wine before
breakfast.
7. If you keep ( make) … such a noise , she’ll
complain.
8. It no use ( attempt)(cè g¾ng làm cái gì).
(have) dinner in 2 minutes.
9. Do you mind ( see) … these photos again?
10.I remember ( try) … ti dress myself for the
first time.
- T asks Ss to do exercises . asks they practice
in pairs.
-Some others to go to the board to do.
-T gets feedback and give answer keys.
-Retell the main points of this lesson.
Aks some Ss to retell the main structure grammar.
Listen and repeat
chorally , individually
Copy down
Listen carefully
Repeat the uses of the “
Asking for favors /
offering assistance and
how to respond “
Work in pairs to give the
example
Practice asking and
answering to draw the
form
Copy down .
Practice asking and
Listen and copy .
Work in groups of three or
four
-Do exercises
Report their results .
Practice speaking the
dialogue
<b>I.Teaching points : By the end of the lesson, Ss will be able to practice all structure </b>
grammar from unit 3 to unit 6 .
- Develop Ss’ four skills.
<b>II. Preparation: -Text books, lesson plan, posters .</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up: </b>
-Asks Ss to retell the new words and read again the dialogue.
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>a)</b>
<b>b)</b>
<b> Warm up : Brainstorming </b>
*Possible answers :
- Clean up the streets
- Help elderly people
- Take part in sports
- Help handicappied / street children
- Collect and empty garbage …..
<b>** Presentation</b> :
<b>Pre </b>–<b> teach vocabulary </b>
- a ret home : a place where old or sick people are cared
for
- an orphanage : a place where children without parents
live
- a stadium ( picture )
<b>* Checking : Rub out and remember </b>
<b> Setting the scene</b> : Introduce the dialogue “ Lan and
Mai are members of the Y&Y organization . They are
talking about the summer activity program”
Lan : …(1…….we collect and empty garbage ?
Mai : at Dong Xuan Market .
Lan : …..(2)…….. we collect ……(3)………?
Mai : On January 9
Lan : ………(4)…….. we start and ……(5)…..?
Mai : ……..(6) …… 8 am and ……(7) … 5 pm .
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to complete the dialogue .
- Call on some pairs to play the role of Lan and mai to
practice the dialogue .
- Give feedback
*Keys:
1. where do 2. when do 3. an empty garbage
4. what time do 5. finish 6. we start at 7. finish at
c. Concept checking :- Ask Ss some questions to check
their understanding
a. When do we “ where “ ?
b. When do we use “ when “ ?
c. When do we use “ what time “ ?
d. Is the date at present or in the future ?
Play game
Listen and repeat
chorally , individually
Copy down
Play game
Listen carefully
Work in pairs to practice
the dialogue
<b>2)</b>
<b>3)</b>
II/
III/
e. What tense do we use in the dialogue ?
=> We use simple present tense to express an action that
happens in the future .
- Ask Ss to practice asking and answering about the
Y&Y activity by using the following cues
- Call on some pairs to practice the dialogue .
- Give feedback
<b> Gerunds : </b>
<b>* Form : Like , love , enjoy , hate + Ving </b>
<b>* Survey : </b>
- Ask Ss to work in groups of three to ask their friends
and stick on the chart .
- Give feedback by asking Ss to report their friends,
hobbies .
Eg : Ba loves playing soccer . He does not like cooking
and especially hate washing dishes . ..
<b>Modals : may , can , could </b>
- Ask Ss to repeat the uses of the offering assistance ,
asking for favors and how to respond .
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to practice the dialogue
- Call on some pairs to practice the dialogue in front of
the class .
- Give feedback
a /A : Can you buy a ticket for me ?
B : Can you take me across the road ?
C : Could you help me with this math problem ?
D : Can you water the flowers in the garden?
b / A : May I help you ?
A : Do you need any help ?
B : Let me help you .
A : Yes . That is very kind of you .
- Ask them to practice the dialogue in front of the class .
<b>* Consolidation: </b>
-Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>*Homework : </b>
1. Copy all the exercises in their notebooks .
2. Prepare the next lesson .
Copy down .
Practice asking and
answering the questions
about the Y&Y activity .
Listen and copy .
Work in groups of three
or four
Report their results .
Repeat the uses of the “
Asking for favors /
offering assistance and
how to respond “
Practice speaking the
dialogue
Listen and copy .
period 40 :
1. We ought …………the wardrobe in the corner opposite the bed.
A. put B. push C. to put D. to push
A. mother tongue B. second language C. foreign language
3. We try to learn all new words ...heart
A. from B. by C.for
4.Many language leaners don't learn all new words they come...
A. along B. with C. across
5. ... remember words better, we can underline or highlight.
A. In order that B. In order to C. In order
6. When I was a little girl, I used to ... my father’s advice.
A. listen B. listen to C. listening to
<b>II. (2ps) Put the verbs in to the correct tenses:</b>
1.The boys like (play) ... games but hate doing lessons.
2.We (start) ... our work on Monday and finish on Thursday.
3.My sister likes ( plant) ………… roses in the garden.
4.The tourist needs (find)….... the police station because he’s lost money.
<b> III.(3ps) Arrange the words or phrases into the correct sentence:</b>
1.her / has to / Lan / chores / do.
………
2.Nga / did / fail / why / English test / her ?
………
3.Because / didn’t learn/ her / she / lesson carefully.
………
<b>IV. (2 ps) change the following sentences in to reported speech:</b>
1/ " Please open your book" Nam said to Hoa.
Nam asked ………
2/ " You should practice speaking English more" Nga said to me.
Nga told ……….
<b> Chữ kí giáo viên Ch÷ kÝ phơ huynh.</b>
……… ………
<b>Period 40 </b>
<i> The end ………</i>
<b>Period 41: Lesson 1 :Getting started +</b>
<b>Listen and read</b>
<b>I.The aims and requests:</b>
- Help ss read and understand of the dialogue between Nam and Na.
- By the end of the lesson . Ss will be able to know more about Na,<sub>s new neighbor . </sub>
- Develop 4 skills: Listening, speaking, reading and writing.
<b>II. Preparation : +T: Textbook , cassette , poster , chalk, CD</b>
+ Ss: textbook, notebook, pen…
<b>III. Steps of the lesson: </b>
<b>1. Organization (1 )</b>’ :- Greeting and checking attendance.
<b>2. Checking up: </b>
<b>3. New lesson:</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I.</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>*Warm up : Getting started </b>
* Answers :
a. grocery store b. stadium
c. wet market d. drug store
e. hairdresser,<sub>s f. swimming pool </sub>
<b>*Pre - reading </b>
- close by (adv) : a short distance
- to serve : give sb food or drink
- a pancake : banh ran
- tasty (a) = delicious (a)
Play game
( whole class )
Listen and copy .
<b>***</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>3.</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV.</b>
<b>V/</b>
<b>* Checking vocabulary : What and where </b>
<b>Guiding questions : </b>
- Set the scene “ Nam and Na are talking about the
place where they live . But Na is new there . “
<b>Questions : </b>
a. How long has Nam lived in that neighborhood ?
b. Where does Na want to go ?
- Ask Ss to listen to the tape and predict the answers
and call on some Ss to read their predictions and
write them on the board .
<b> While - reading : </b>
*
a. He has lived there for 10 years .
b. Na wants to go to a restaurant .
* Ask Ss to do the exercise 2 / 64 individually , then
compare with their partners .
- Call on some Ss to read their answers and give
feedback : a. new b. last week c. tired
d. restaurant e. Hue f. pancakes
* Answers given :
a. Nam has lived here for 10 years .
b. Yes. my mother is too tired to cook .
c. The restaurant serves Hue food .
d. Hue food is very good.
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to practice asking and
answering
<i><b>=> Questions </b></i>
a. How long has Nam lived here ?
b. Is Na,<sub>s mother tired ? </sub>
c. What kind of food does the restaurant serve ?
d. What is the food like ?
<b>** Post - reading : Write </b>
- Ask Ss to write a passage about their neighborhood by
answering the following questions
a. How long have you lived in your neighborhood ?
b. Do you like it ? Why ?
c . Is there a restaurant / post – office / market /
bank / shop in your neighborhood ?
d.How do you do to keep your neighborhood clean ?
- Move around the class and help Ss
- Call on some Ss to read their writings aloud .
- Correct mistakes .
<b>* Consolidation:</b>
-Retell the main points of this leson.
<b>* Homework : </b>
1. Write the complete writing about their neighborhood .
2. Do exercise in workbook .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
Copy down
Play game
Listen to the scene and
work in groups to
predict the answers to
the guiding questions .
Report their
predictions .
Read the dialogue to
check their predictions
Work individually
Work in pairs to
practice asking and
answering the
questions
- T give them marks if
necessary.
Open pairs -> closed
pairs
Write individually
Demonstrate their
writings in front of
class.
Listen and copy down
homeworks.
<b>Period 42 lesson 2 : </b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>* Warm up : + Chatting </b>
- Show a letter and ask Ss some questions
+ What is this ?
+ Where can I post it to my friend ?
+ How can I post it ?
+ How much ?
+ Is it more expensive when I send a parcel ?
+ Have you ever sent a letter or a parcel ?
Lead in the new lesson .
<b>* Presentation : </b>
<b>+ Pre- teach vocabulary : </b>
- air – mail : letter or parcel sent by air
- surface mail : letter or parcel sent by bus , train or ship
…
- Parcel ( n) buu pham buu kien.
- charge (v / n ) : le phi, cuoc phi.
* Checking : Rub out and remember
<b>+ Reading comprehension </b>
- Set the scene “ Mrs Kim wants to send a parcel to Qui
Nhon , so she has to go to the post office .”
- Give Ss some questions and ask Ss to work in pairs to
compare their answers .
- Ask Ss to read the dialogue and find out the answers
a. Does Mrs Kim send the parcel airmail or surface
mail ? Why ?
b. What is the weight of her parcel ?
c. How much does she pay ?
- Call on Ss to ask and answer the questions
* Answers :
a. Mrs Kim send the parcel surface mail because it is
much cheaper .
b. Her parcel is five kilograms .
c. She pays 19, 200 dongs .
<b>** Practice : </b>
- Call on a student to play role of Mrs Kim and practice
Play game
( whole class )
Listen and repeat
chorally , individually
( whole class )
Play game
Listen carefully .
Work in pairs
Read the dialogue to
fine out the answers .
Practice asking and
answering the
questions .
<b>III/</b>
<b>1</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>3.</b>
<b>4.</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
the dialogue with teacher ( clerk )
- Call on some pairs to practice the dialogue . Correct
- Call on some pairs to practice the dialogue in front of
class .
<b>* Further practice : </b>
- Set the scene and ask Ss to make the dialogue
+ Mrs Lan wants to post a letter air mail
- Ask Ss to make the dialogue between Lan and the clerk
in the post office .
- Elicit and encourage Ss to make the dialogue
themselves .
Expected dialogue
<i><b>Clerk : Can I help you ? </b></i>
<i><b>Mrs Lan : I want to send a letter to Kontom . </b></i>
<i><b>Clerk :Do you want to send it airmail or surface mail ?</b></i>
<i><b>Mrs Lan : I send it airmail . How much is it ? </b></i>
<i><b>Clerk : Let me see . Mmm , 15 grams , it is only </b></i>
<i><b>1,200 dongs . </b></i>
<i><b>Mrs Lan : Here you are . </b></i>
<i><b>Clerk : Thank you . </b></i>
<i><b>- Get Ss to practice the dialogue in pairs </b></i>
<i><b>- Give Ss some situations : </b></i>
2. Postcard / HCM city / airmail / 15 g
3. Parcel / Ca Mau ? air mail / 2 kg
4. Parcel / Buon Me Thuot / surface / 5 kgs .
- Divide class into 3 groups , each prepares a dialogue
- Call on 2 pairs from each group to practice their
dialogue .
- Get Ss to work in pairs , practicing three dialogues and
move around class to help Ss .
<b>* Consolidation: - Retell the main points of this lesson.</b>
<b>* Homework : </b>
1. Copy the three dialogues in their notebooks .
2. Prepare the next lesson .
with teacher .
Work in open pairs
Work in closed pairs .
Practice the dialogues ,
using the situations .
( whole class )
Work in pairs
Work in groups
Work in open pairs
Work in closed pairs
Listen and copy .
<b>Period 43 </b>
<b>Lesson 3</b>
<b>I. Teaching points:</b> By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to know what Na is going
to do on the weekend by listening .
<b>II. Teaching aids :</b>Text books , cassette , chalks , boards , lesson plan. posters.
<b>I . Organization: </b>
- Greeting and checking attendance.
<b>II. Checking up:</b>
Two Ss go to the board to make the similar dialogue about to send a letter or parcel.
- T corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>3.</b>
<b>4.</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>3.</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>* Warm up : Brainstorming and guessing </b>
- Ask Ss to look at 4 advertisements of “ what is on
this week ? “ and get Ss to guess what is in the bank
2-3-4
<b>* Movies </b>
<b>* Place -> Stadium </b>
School ground
City
Town ground
<b>* Activity -> drama / play </b>
English Speak Club / Contest
Dancing
Picture Exhibition
Music
<b>* Place -> Gallery </b>
Culture house
School
City hall
<b>*Pre - listening : </b>
- Set the scene “ Na is new in the neighborhood .
She is talking to Nam about what she is going to do
on the weekend .”
- Ask Ss to listen to the tape twice and give the
answers and fill in the blanks in each advertisement
+ Listening task :
- Let Ss listen to the tape twice and give the answers
- Give feedback
a. The new comer b. Town Ground
c. English speaking contest d . Culture House
Listening task 2 :
- Ask Ss to read the statements in the exercises 2/66
- Get Ss to guess which is true , which is false which
has no information
- Ask Ss to share their ideas with their friends .
- Give feedback
- Let Ss listen to the conversation again n and tick in
the correct boxes : True ? False or No information
Statements T F No
a. Na does not know the b
neighborhood very well
b. Na does not like movies
c. Na will go to the photo
exhibition this weekend
d. Na will not go to the
English speaking Contest
f. Nam is a soccer fan .
X
X
X
X
X
X
+ Comprehension questions
- Ask Ss some questions to check their
understanding of the conversation .
- Turn on the tape again .
- Play game
( whole class )
- Look at 4
advertisements of :
“What is on this
week ?”
- And then get Ss to
guess what is in the
- Listen and copy
- Work individually
- Work individually
- Work in pairs
- Listen to the
conversation again and
tick in the corrects
boxes
- Practice asking and
answering the
questions.
( whole class )
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
a. Does Na like movies ?
b. Why will not she go to see the film “The New
comer “ ?
c. Why will not Na go to the photo exhibition ?
<b>* Post - Listening : </b>
- Ask Ss to work in groups to talk to their friends
about what Na is going to do this weekend .
- Call on some volunteers from each group to tell the
whole class about Na .
<b>* Consolidation: - Retell the main points of the </b>
lesson.
<b>* Homework : </b>
1. Write a short passage about what Na is going to
do .
2. Do exercises in workbook .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
- Work in group .
Talk about What Na is
going to do this
weekend.
- Some Ss retell the
main points .
- Listen and copy
down homeworks
<b>Answer for written test 2 </b>
(grade 8)
-
-
Unit 7 :
My neighborhood
<b>Period 45 </b>
<b>lesson 4 : </b>
<b>I. Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to understand the passage </b>
about a new shopping Mall .
- Develop Ss reading skill .
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbook , cassette , chalk , board , posters and lesson plan.</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance .</b>
II. Checking up :
- Ask 2 Ss to go to the board to answer some questions say about contents of the last
lesson .- T corrects and give them marks.
Page 79 School year : 2010- 2011
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>**</b>
words as quickly as possible .
1. a place where you can buy everything
2. A place where you can buy vegetables and fruit .
3. A place where you can buy books .
4. A place where you can come to eat .
5. A place where you can come to see the movies .
6. A person who comes to the store and buys
something.
=> Lead in the new lesson
<b>** Pre - reading : Introduce the topic of the passage</b>
reading and some new words to Ss :
* Pre – teach vocabulary :
- a roof ( picture )
- convenient = thuan loi
- a selection = a process of choosing carefully .
- available = san co de dung , co the de dung
- a mall = many stores , restaurants , even movies
theaters are under one roof .
- a resident = cu dan
<i><b>* Checking vocabulary : What and where </b></i>
*. Brainstorming :
- Set the scene “ In Nam,<sub>s neighborhood , there is a </sub>
new shopping mall .
- Ask Ss to think about the convenience of the mall .
Possible answers :
- wide selection of goods
- lower prices / buy many things at the same
time
- have fun or relax while shopping
- <i><b>Lower prices </b></i> <i><b> wide selection of goods </b></i>
<b>*While - reading </b>
- Ask Ss to read the text silently and compare their
or get more information .
- Give feedback
- Explain the meanings of some phrases rapidly
+ under one roof + shop in comfort
+ take their business + offer a wider selection
+ especially stores + have been concerned
about
* True / False statements
- Have Ss look at the statements in the box and get
them to read the text again and decide which
statements are true , which are false .
Statements True False
1. A mall is open six days a week .
2. There are more than 50 stores in
the mall .
3. Everyone in the neighborhood is
pleased about the new mall .
4. It will be more comfortable to
shop in the mall than in the present
shopping area .
5. Some of the stores on Tran Phu
Street may have to close .
- Have Ss correct the false statements
Play game
( whole class )
Listen and copy
Listen and repeat
chorally , individually
Copy down .
Play games .
Listen and do the task
Read them aloud and
copy .
Work individually
Ss look at the
statements in the box
and get them to read
the text again and
decide which
statements are true ,
which are false .
Work in pairs
Ss correct the false
statements
- One by one
<b>Period 46 </b>
<b>Lesson 5</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>???</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>*Warm up : * Chatting </b>
<i>1. Have you ever written a notice ? </i>
<i>2. To whom ? </i>
<i>3. What for ? </i>
<i>4. What type ? </i>
=> Lead in the new lesson .
<b>* Pre - writing : Introduce the topic of the writing </b>
* Pre- teach vocabulary :
- effects (n) = tac dong , tac dung , hieu qua
- contact (v) = lien lac
- hardware store = dung cu dong dung trong nha
* Guiding questions
a. Why are the residents and store owners on Tran
Phu street going to hold a meeting ?
b. When will they hold a meeting ? What time ?
c. Where will they hold the meeting ?
- Get Ss to read the notice and answer some
questions to check their understanding.
- Call on some pairs to practice asking answering the
questions .
- Give feedback
a. To discuss the effects of the new mall
b. They will hold the meeting on May 20 at 8 p.m
c. They will hold the meeting at 12 Hang Dao
- Let Ss know how to write a notice , not write full
sentences .
* Reading :
- Ask Ss to read the passage and ask some questions
Play game
( whole class)
Listen and copy .
- Repeat in chorus.
Work in pairs
Read individually
Practice asking and
answering the
questions.
<b>*</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
to check their understanding , get them to use short
answers .
1. What is the English Speaking club going to hold ?
2. Where and when will it be held ?
3. What time ?
4. Who is the person contact ?
- Call on some pairs to practice asking and
answering the questions .
<b>* While -writing : </b>
- Get Ss to write the notice individually
- Monitor and help them write
- Ask Ss to share with their partners
- Check some notices and correct them
- Write the model notice on the board
Suggested answers :
<i><b>The school English Speaking club</b></i>
Holding A Speaking Contest to
celebrate teacher,<sub>s day</sub>
<i><b>Date : November 15 </b></i>
<i><b>Time : 7.30 pm to 10.oo pm </b></i>
<i><b>Place : Hall 204 , Building G</b></i>
<i><b>Please contact Ms .Tran Thi Thu Hang of class </b></i>
<i><b>8H at the above address for more information .</b></i>
<b>*Post - writing : </b>
- Ask Ss to write one notice about their class
meeting
- Get them to work in group
- Call on some Ss to demonstrate in front of class .
- Give feedback .
<b>* Consolidation: </b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson .
<b>*Homework : </b>
1. Write the completed notice in their notebooks .
2. Do exercises in workbook .
Ss to read the passage
and ask some
questions to check
their understanding ,
get them to use short
answers .
Work in pairs
Practice asking and
answering the
questions.
Work individually
Work in pairs
Whole class
Read the correct notice
Ss to write one notice
about their class
meeting
Work in group
- Retell the main
points .
Listen and copy down
homeworks.
<b>Period 47: </b>
<b> A/ The aims: </b>
<b>I.Teaching points : By the end of the lesson, Ss will be able to use Present Perfect </b>
Tense and some adjectives to make comparisons .
Develop Ss’ four skills.
<b>II. Preparation: -Text books, lesson plan, posters .</b>
Page 83 School year : 2010- 2011
<b>I/</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>1</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>4.</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>***</b>
the board.
- Divide the class into 2 teams
- Get Ss form 2 teams to go to the board and write
each pair of infinitive – past participle
be see collected go
worked
lived do seen eat
attended
write been written eaten
work
attend done live collect gone
Answers :
be – been ; write – written ; go – gone
live – lived ; see – seen ; collect –
do – done attend – attended ;eat – eaten
work – worked
- Get Ss to repeat in chorus and remember the past
participles of irregular verbs .
<b>* Presentation : </b>
- Set the scene “ Na is new in Nam ,<sub>s neighborhood .</sub>
They are talking to each other .”
- Give Ss an open dialogue between Nam and Na ,
then ask them to complete it
Na : How long ….. you … in this neighborhood ?
Nam : I ... here …..10 years .
Na : Really . It is a long time .
* Answers : have – lived / have – lived – for
- Ask Ss to repeat the dialogue and ask them to
practice in pairs .
<b>=> Form : have / has + past participle</b>
* Use : to talk about something which started in
the past and continues up to the present
We often uses “ For “ and “ Since “ with the
<b>Present Perfect Tense : For + length of time</b>
<b>Since + starting point</b>
<b> Exercises : </b>
* Ex 2 :
- Ask Ss to look at exercise 2 / 69 and decide which
is the length of time and which is starting point .
- Read out a phrase , and Ss to add Since or For
- Go on until Ss can remember how to use For/Since
* Ex 3 : - Give the cues written on cards and ask Ss
to make full sentences .
- Correct their pronunciation
Example : I / live / here / last week
I have lived here since last week
*.Ex 4: Ask Ss to complete the conversations
- Have them work in pairs
- Call on some pairs to practice in front of class .
- Give feedback
1. have been 2. hope 3. have lived 4. is
5. want 6. looks 7. have been 8. have seen
- Ask Ss to work in closed pairs .
<b>*. Ex 5 * Game : Pelmanism </b>
<i>differen</i>
<i>t</i> <i>cheap</i> <i>expensive</i> <i>long</i> <i>same</i>
Play game
( whole class )
write each pair of
infinitive – past
participle
Repeat chorally ,
individually , then copy
Listen and copy
Work in pairs
Practice in front of
class .
Listen and copy .
Ss to look at exercise 2 /
69 and decide which is
the length of time and
which is starting point .
- Read out a phrase , and
Ss to add Since or For
Work on the whole class
Work individually
Work in pairs
Work in groups
<b>Period 48 lesson 1:</b>
<b>*Teaching points: By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to talk about the city life and the </b>
country life .
- Develop 4 skills: Listening, speaking, reading and writing.
<b>II. Preparation: + Teacher’s preparation: Textbooks , cassette , chalks , boards, posters , </b>
lesson plan.
+ Ss’preparation: textbook, workbook, notebook,pen…
<b>1. Organizaton(1 ):</b>’ -Greeting and checking attendance.
<b>2. Checking up(4 ):</b>’ - Ask Ss to go to the board to do Ex L.f 3.
- T corrects and gives them marks.
<b>3. New lesson: </b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>* Warm up : * Chatting </b>
- Talk to Ss about life in the city and life in the country
by asking some questions
<i>1. Where do you live ? </i>
<i>2. Do you want to live in the city ? Why ? </i>
<i>3. Do you want to live in the country ? Why ? </i>
=> Lead in the new lesson
<b> * Pre -reading : Introduce the topic of the passage </b>
reading and some new words .
*. Pre – teach vocabulary :
- a relative = uncles , aunts cousins
- peaceful = quiet and calm (a)
- permanently (adv) : its means existing all the time
- accessible = co the den gan duoc
- medical facilities = cac phuong tien y te
<i>* Checking vocabulary : Rub out and remember </i>
* Brainstorming <b> ( Getting started ) </b>
- Get Ss to talk about city life and country life . The
words in the box of getting started may help you .
Possible answers :
- tall buildings - beautiful views
- plenty kinds of goods - fresh food
- polluted air - fresh air
- traffic jams - friendly
- entertainment - peaceful busy
<b>** While </b>–<b> reading : </b>
*. True / false statements
Statements True False
1. Na lives in the city
2. Na went to a village which has
some relatives lives there .
x
x
Chatting
( whole class )
Listen and copy
Listen and repeat
chorally
Copy down
Play game
Ss to talk about city life
and country life.
- Play agame in two
teams.
Work in groups
Work in groups to
predict
city life
city life
country
life
country
<b>2.</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
3. The village is very peaceful and
quiet
4. Hoa prefers the city life
x
x
- Turn on the tape and ask Ss to work in groups to
predict the true / false statements .
- Call on some Ss to report their predictions and write
them on the board.
- Ask Ss to read the dialogue between Na and Hoa and
compare their ideas
- Give feedback and get more information
- Call on some pairs to practice the dialogue
<b>*. Comprehension questions : </b>
- Get Ss to work in pairs to answer the questions in
ex 2 / 73
- Call on some pairs to practice asking answering the
questions in front of class .
- Give feedback
<i>a. Na has been to Kin Lien village </i>
<i>b. She was there for the weekend </i>
<i>c. to her , the countryside is peaceful and quiet and </i>
<i>there is nothing to do . </i>
<i>d. There is no libraries , no movies , no supermarket , </i>
<i>no zoos …</i>
<i>e. Country life is becoming better . Many remote area </i>
<i>are getting electricity . People can now have things like </i>
<i>refrigerators and TV , medical facilities are more </i>
<i>accessible . </i>
- Ask Ss to work in closed pairs
<i><b>**/ Post - reading : *Discussion </b></i>
- Divide the class into 4 groups . Two groups include Ss
who prefer the city life and the others include Ss who
prefer the country life .
- Ask Ss to work in groups to answer the questions
“ Do you prefer the city or the country life ?Why ? “
- Call on 4 pioneers from 4 groups to show their ideas
before class .
<b>** Consolidation: - Retell the main points .</b>
<b>** Homework : Learn by heart new words and copy </b>
two lines for each word .
– Copy the answers in their notebooks .
- Prepare the next lesson .
Read the dialogue ,
compare their ideas
Practice the dialogue in
pairs
Work in pairs
- some pairs to practice
asking answering the
questions in front of
class .
Practice asking and
answering the questions
Work in groups
Demonstrate their ideas
in front of class .
- Retell the main points .
Listen and copy down
homeworks.
<b>lesson 2 </b>
<b>I . Teaching points :By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to practice speaking </b>
about the changes of a place
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbooks , pictures , poster , lesson plan. </b>
<b>I . Organization : - Greeting and checking attendance .</b>
<b>II. Checking up : - Asks 2 Ss to do exercises : </b>
a) Many lakes / rivers / become / dry . =>
b) Weather / get / worse . =>
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson : </b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>* Warm up and pre - speaking </b>
<b>Word square</b>
- Ask Ss to find out 7 adjectives
<b>E</b> <b>X</b> <b>P</b> <b>E</b> <b>N</b> <b>S</b> <b>I</b> <b>B</b>
<b>O</b> <b>A</b> <b>M</b> <b>D</b> <b>N</b> <b>U</b> <b>V</b> <b>E</b>
<b>U</b> <b>B</b> <b>O</b> <b>I</b> <b>S</b> <b>V</b> <b>E</b> <b>A</b>
<b>I</b> <b>C</b> <b>D</b> <b>R</b> <b>T</b> <b>R</b> <b>U</b>
<b>Y</b> <b>L</b> <b>E</b> <b>T</b> <b>L</b> <b>L</b> <b>A</b> <b>T</b>
<b>S</b> <b>M</b> <b>R</b> <b>Y</b> <b>H</b> <b>G</b> <b>I</b>
<b>U</b> <b>O</b> <b>N</b> <b>O</b> <b>I</b> <b>S</b> <b>Y</b> <b>F</b>
<b>B</b> <b>P</b> <b>T</b> <b>F</b> <b>D</b> <b>E</b> <b>L</b> <b>U</b>
- Ask Ss to work in 2 teams
- Ask Ss to go to the board and circle the word they
find
- The team which circles more words will win the
game .
Modern – dirty – busy – noisy – tall –
expensive – beautiful
Setting the scene “ Hoa,<sub>s grand father is 78 “ </sub>
- Five years ago , she was 73 and she was stronger
than she is now .
- Ask Ss to make a sentence about her health
=> Hoa,<sub>s grand father is getting weaker </sub>
<b>+ Form : am / is / are + V-ing </b>
<b>+ Use : used to describe changes with get and </b>
<b>become </b>
<b>**While </b>–<b> speaking</b> :
- Ask Ss to look at the two pictures on page 73 and
talk to their partners about the changes of the town .
The words in the box under the pictures may help
you
- Write the word prompts on the board so that Ss can
speak easily
- traffic - > busy
- sky -> cloudy
- houses -> high
- city -> beautiful
- The traffic is getting busier .
- There are more tall buildings and houses .
- The houses are getting more modern
- The town is becoming more beautiful .
- The streets are becoming cleaner / larger / noisier
* Language focus 1 : Ask Ss to practice the
dialogue as example
S1 : Is the boat to Qui Nhon leaving at 11. 30 ?
S2 : Is that good fortune ?
S1 : That is right
S2 : I am very sorry . It has been delayed .
Work in group
Ss to find out 7
adjectives.
Ss to go to the board
and circle the word
they find
Work in the whole
class .
Listen and copy
Work in pairs
- Ss to look at the two
pictures on page 73
and talk to their
partners about the
changes of the town
Ss to work in pairs
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
S1 : Oh , no !
S2 : Now , it is leaving at 13 . 45
- Give them the shipping information and ask them
to make similar dialogues
** Language focus 2 : Complete the dialogue.Use
- Asks Ss do ex in pairs. then to go ti the board to
rewrite on the board.
<b>* Post - speaking : </b>
- Ask Ss to work in groups and talk about changes in
their hometown / neighborhood .
- Call on volunteer from each group to show their
ideas before the class . Other groups can add in their
ideas .
<b>Consolidation:Retell the main points of this lesson.</b>
<b>* Homework : </b>
Write some sentences , using Present Progressive
Tense to describe changes in their school
Work in group
Work individually
Ss do ex in pairs. then
to go ti the board to
rewrite on the board.
Listen and copy down
homeworks.
<b>Period 50: </b>
<b>lesson 3: </b>
<b>I. Teaching points: By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to complete the dialogue by </b>
listening . Then do exercises in Language focus 3 + 4.
- Develop Ss’ listening skill.
<b>II. Teaching aids : Text book , cards , cassette , lesson plan, posters </b>, radio , CD.
<b>I . Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up : - Asks 2 Ss to go to the board to talk about the changes of their town or </b>
their villages in five years ago.
- T corrects and give them marks.
III. New lesson:
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b> Warm up : * Matching</b>
- Prepare eight cards with phrases on them
- Write eight verbs on the board ( play , do , watch , go ,
clean , have , phone , speak )
- Divide the class into 2 teams
- Hand out each team 8 cards
- Ask Ss to stick the cards with phrases besides the
suitable verbs
- The team which is faster is the winner
* Answers :
- play table tennis
- do my homework
- watch a program
- go to a violin lesson
- clean the house
- have a meeting
- phone my aunt , Mrs Hang
- speak to Mom
=> Lead in the new lesson .
<b>* Pre - listening </b>
Work in group
Ss to stick the cards with
phrases besides the
suitable verbs
Listen and repeat
chorally and
individually
Copy down
Listen and copy
Work in groups to
<b>II/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
<b>VI/</b>
- Set the scene “ Aunt Hang is talking to Lan on the
phone . She is coming to visit Lan in Hanoi “
- Ask Ss to predict information in the dialogue .
- Turn on the tape and check their predictions
- Let them listen twice and find out the missing words
individually .
- Ask Ss to share their answers with their partners
- Call some Ss to read their results
Give feedback
1. that 2. this 3. It is 4. where
5. from 6. coming 7. next week 8. arriving
9. Thursday 10 . late 11. afternoon 12
. speak 13. my 14 . get her.
<i><b>Language focus:</b></i>
* Ex 3 : Present Progressive Tense is used to describe
changes with “ get “ and “ become “
* Drill : Prepare six cards of cues
a. The boys / get / tall
b. The old men / become / weak
c. It / become / dark
d. The weather / get / cold
f. The school yard / become / cleaner
- Model first two cues , then whole class repeat
chorally , then some Ss read out individually
- Give a new cue and go on until most of the Ss in class
can remember the structure .
* Comparative and superlative adjectives
- Remind Ss of the forms of comparative and superlative
adjectives
<i>* Comparative : <b>Short adj - er + than + object </b></i>
<i><b> More long adj + than + object </b></i>
<i><b>* Superlative : The + short adjective - est </b></i>
<i><b> The most + long adjective</b></i>
* Irregular adjectives
good/ well – better – the best
bad – worse – the worst
many – more – the most
little – less – the least
* Ex 4 : Have Ss work in pairs to make comparisons
between the city and the country .
Ex : The air in the country is fresher than in the city
- Let each Student read aloud one of the sentences they
have made .
- Give feedback
<b>* Post - listening </b>
- Ask Ss to play the roles of Lan and Aunt Hang to
practice the dialogue .
<b>* Consolidation : </b>
- Retell the main points
<b>* Homework : </b>
1. Copy down the completed dialogue in their notebooks
2. Do exercises in work book
3. Prepare the next lesson .
predict .
Listen to the tape to
check their predictions
Listen again and share
their answers with their
friends .
Read their answers
aloud .
Work in pairs to practice
the dialogue
Look at the board.
Work in pairs.
- Do LF 3+ 4 .
whole class repeat
chorally , then some Ss
read out individually
Asks Ss to retell the
main structure grammar
about the forms of
comparative and
superlative adjectives .
- One by one.
Ss work in pairs to make
comparisons between
the city and the country .
- Each Student read
aloud one of the
sentences they have
made .
- Ss to play the roles of
Lan and Aunt Hang to
practice the dialogue .
- Retell the main points
- One by one.
Listen and copy down
homeworks.
<b>Period 51. lesson 4 : </b>
<b>I . Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to understand the text about </b>
one of the social problems .
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbooks , poster , cassette , CD, lesson plan.</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up :</b>
- Asks Ss to go to the board to retell the main structure grammar of last lesson.
-T corrects and give them marks.
III. New lesson:
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>*Warm up : * Jumbled words </b>
- Write the words with disordered letters on the board .
+ Fulentipl -> plentiful
+ taneru -> nature
+ loofd -> flood
+ roestdy -> destroy
+ viroped -> provide
+ suertl -> result
+ ciliestial -> facilities
- Ask them to write the correct words on the board and
repeat chorally , individually
=> Lead in the new lesson .
<b>* Pre- reading :</b>
- Introduce the topic of the passage reading and some
new words to Ss .
<b>* Pre - teach vocabulary : </b>
- rural (adj ) : something deals with the countryside
- strain (n) = su qua tai ( dan so )
- typhoon (n) = storm (n)
- drought (n) : hot and dry weather for a long time
-( to )struggle = dau tranh
- migrant (n) : a person who moves from one place to
another especially in order to find work .
- (to) increase = tang len , tang them , Gia tang.
<i>* Checking vocabulary : What and where </i>
*. Brainstorming :
- Ask Ss to think of the difficulties of farmer s, <sub>life .</sub>
Possible answers :
droughts / the weather / hard work / no vacations / lack
of clean water / electricity / insects destroy harvests ..
- Ask Ss to work in groups to guess how farmers deal
with difficulties
- Call on some Ss to report their predictions and write
them on the board .
<b>*While - reading : </b>
- Let Ss listen to the tape and read the text silently to
- Answer “ What do many farmers do to solve their
problem ? “
=> They have to move to the city so that they can get
well – paid jobs .
Work in group
Listen and copy down
Listen and repeat
chorally , individually ,
then copy down .
Play game
Copy down new lesson.
Work individually.
Work in groups to guess
how farmers deal with
difficulties
Some Ss to report their
predictions and write
them on the board .
Demonstrate in front of
class
Ss listen to the tape and
read the text silently to
check their predictions .
- Work individually.
-Some Ss to read the text
in front of class .
Page 89 School year : 2010- 2011
Difficulties of farmer s, life
<b>2.</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
- Call on some Ss to read the text in front of class .
<b>* Gap- filling :</b>
- Ask Ss to work in pairs o complete summary , using
the information from the passage .
- Call on some volunteers to report their results
- Give feedback
<i>1. leaving 2. home 3. city 4. rural </i>
<i>5. city 6. problems 7. schools 8. hospitals </i>
<i> 9. problem 10 . world </i>
- Call on some Ss to read the complete passage aloud
*Finding the words
- Ask Ss to read the text again and work with their
partners
- Call them to report their results
- Give feedback
<i>a. rural b. plentiful c. increase </i>
d. strain e. tragedy f. urban
<b>*Post - reading : Discussion </b>
- Give a situation : If you were a Minister , what would
you do for farmers ?
- Ask Ss to work in groups to discuss
* Suggested answers :
- build streets , theaters , stadiums in the countryside
- build schools , hospitals
- provide clean water , electricity , facilities
- build factory .
- Call on 4 volunteers from 4 groups to show their ideas
before the class .
<b>* Consolidation: </b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>*Homework : </b>
1. Write 5 things that government should do for the rural
areas .
2. Do exercises in workbook .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
Ss to work in pairs o
complete summary ,
using the information
from the passage .
Listen to the tape and
read the text to check
their predictions
Answer the question
Read the text aloud .
Work in pairs
Read their results .
Read the complete
summary .
Read the text again and
do the exercise 2 / 75
Read the complete
results .
Work in groups to
discuss
Show their ideas before
class .
Listen and copy .
<b>Country life and city life</b>
<b>Period 52 . </b>
<b>Lesson 5 : </b>
<b>***</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
<b>*Warm up : Revision </b>
- Ask Ss to put the outline for an informal letter in
the correct order .
- Prepare 6 cards with 6 outlines on them .
- Call 6 Ss to hold them and stand in a random order
- Ask some other Ss to rearrange them in the correct
order .
- Write the answer on the board and ask Ss to copy .
1. Heading
- Writer,<sub>s address / Date </sub>
- Dear ………... ,
2. opening
3. Body
4. closing
<b>*Pre- writing : </b>
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to answer the questions .
- Call on some pairs to practice asking and
answering the questions
- Give feedback
<b>*While … writing : </b>
- Ask Ss to write letters to friends about their
neighborhood
- Let them write individually .
- Have them compare with their partners and correct
if they can .
* Suggested letter :
<i>( Writer,<sub>s address)</sub></i>
<i>( Date ) </i>
<i><b>Dear ...., </b></i>
<i><b>I live in ….. , a small town . My family has a large </b></i>
<i><b>house with four rooms and a small garden . My </b></i>
<i><b>sister and I share one bedroom . From the </b></i>
<i><b>bedroom window , I can see a beautiful park with </b></i>
<i><b>green tress , flowers and a pond . we do not live far</b></i>
<i><b>form my school so I usually walk there . </b></i>
<i><b>In my neighborhood , there is a swimming pool </b></i>
<i><b>and a beautiful park . On the weekend , I often go </b></i>
<i><b>swimming with my friends . Early in the morning ,</b></i>
<i><b>I always jog with my sister around the park . But </b></i>
<i><b>the thing I like best in my neighborhood is the </b></i>
<i><b>public library near my school . There I not only </b></i>
<i><b>can study and read books but also watch video and</b></i>
<i><b>learn how to use the computer . </b></i>
<i><b>Do you have a library like that in your </b></i>
<i><b>neighborhood ? Is there anything interesting in </b></i>
<i><b>the place where you live ? Write to me. I would </b></i>
<i><b>like to say goodbye now.</b></i>
<i><b>I am looking forwards to hearing from you soon.</b></i>
<i><b>Love , </b></i>
<i>( Signature ) </i>
Work on the whole
class .
Listen and copy down
Work in pairs to
practice asking and
answering the
questions
Work individually
Compare with their
partners
Ss to write letters to
friends about their
neighborhood
- Works individually.
<b>*Post - writing : * Correction </b>
- Choose some letters to correct before class and
ask them to read them aloud .
<b>* Consolidation: </b>
- Reteel the main points of the letter.
<b>*Homework : </b>
1. Write their letters on their notebooks
2. Prepare the next lesson .
Exchange their
writings to correct .
Listen and copy .
Choose some letters to
correct before class
and ask them to read
them aloud .
- Retell the main
points.
Copy down
homeworks.
<b>Period 53 . </b>
REVISION
<b>I.Teaching points : By the end of the lesson, Ss will be able to practice all structure </b>
grammar from unit 1 to unit 8 .
- Develop Ss’ four skills.
<b>II. Preparation: -Text books, lesson plan, posters .</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up: </b>
-Asks Ss to retell the new words and read again the dialogue.
- Two others to retell the main structure grammar .
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>*Warm up : * Matching </b>
A B Key
1. play
2. do
3. watch
4. go
5. clean
6. have
7. phone
8. speak
a. to Mom
b. table tennis
c. a program
d. a meeting
e. my aunt , Mrs Hang
f. the house
g. my homework
h. to violin lesson
1.b
2.g
3.c
4.h
5.f
6.d
7.e
8.a
<b>a. Present simple : S + V(es/s)….</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>***</b>
eg: I go on holiday twice a year.
* Present simple to talk about general truths - It is
used to express an action which is always true .
<b>b. Past simple :</b>
<b> S + V (ed/ qkbqt)/ was / were + ….</b>
eg:I missed the train this morning .
<b>c. (not) adjective + enough + to </b>–<b> infinitive </b>
Eg: He is old enough to see that film .
<b> She is not clever enough to do this thing . </b>
<b>● Grammar Unit 2: </b>
Talk about intentions with going to : Introduce the
form and use of going to
- <b>Form : S + be going to + infinitive </b>
- Use : express an intention
<b>● Grammar Unit 3 </b>
<i><b>Reflexive Pronouns </b></i>
<b>- > Form : We use I with myself </b>
You ... yourself / yourselves
He ...himself
She ...herself
We ...ourselves
They ... themselves
It ... itself
- Emphasis( nhan manh, tam quan trong) pronouns :
Used to emphasize a person or a thing .
Eg : She cut herself .
John saw himself in the mirror .
*Ex 2 : Ask Ss to use the suitable verbs in the
Present Progressive Tense to complete the exercise
- Get Ss to work in pairs
- Call on some pairs to practice the dialogues before
class and correct
=> What tense do we use in 6 dialogues ?
What is the form ?
Look at the adverbs of time in the dialogue . Are
they at present or in the future ?
<i> * Present Progressive Tense is used to talk about </i>
<i>the future . </i>
*Ex 1 : Ask Ss to practice the dialogue as example
S1 : Is the boat to Qui Nhon leaving at 11. 30 ?
S2 : Is that good fortune ?
S1 : That is right
S2 : I am very sorry . It has been delayed .
S1 : Oh , no !
S2 : Now , it is leaving at 13 . 45
- Give them the shipping information and ask them
to make similar dialogues
*Ex 3 : Present Progressive Tense is used to describe
changes with “ get “ and “ become “
* Drill : Prepare six cards of cues
a. The boys / get / tall
b. The old men / become / weak
c. It / become / dark
Work in pairs
Answer the questions
Work in pairs
Work individually
Repeat chorally ,
individually
Repeat the form of
comparative and
superlative adjectives
Listen and copy
Work in pairs
<b>***</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
<b>VI/</b>
d. The weather / get / cold
e. The students / get / better
f. The school yard / become / cleaner
- Model first two cues , then whole class repeat
chorally , then some Ss read out individually
- Give a new cue and go on until most of the Ss in
class can remember the structure .
<i><b>* Comparative and superlative adjectives </b></i>
- Remind Ss of the forms of comparative and
superlative adjectives
<b>* Comparative : Short adj - er + than + object </b>
<b> More long adj + than + object </b>
<b>* Superlative : The + short adjective - est </b>
<b> The most + long adjective</b>
* Irregular adjectives
good/ well – better – the best
bad – worse – the worst
many – more – the most
little – less – the least
●
Ex 4 : Have Ss work in pairs to make comparisons
between the city and the country .
Ex : The air in the country is fresher than in the city
- Let each Student read aloud one of the sentences
they have made .
- Give feedback
<b>*Further practice : </b>
- Ask Ss to read the advertisements then ask them
some questions to check their understanding
+ what are advertised ?
( an apartment , a villa and a house )
+ How old are they ?
( The apartment is 2 years old , the villa is 5 years
old and the house is new )
+ How much do we pay per month ?
( 900,000 dongs for the apartment , 6,6 million
dongs for the house and 7,8 million dongs for the
- Game “ Nought and Crosses “ , using comparative
and superlative adjectives
old expensive big
expensive small hot
big beautiful old
Eg : - The villa is older than the apartment
- The house is more expensive than the apartment
.
<b>* Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main points of some Structure grammar.
<b>*Homework : </b>
1/Redo all the exercises and copy down
2/ Prepare the next lesson .
Listen and answer the
questions
Play game
( whole class )
Ss work in pairs to
make comparisons
between the city and
the country .
Ss to read the
advertisements then
ask them some
questions to check
their understanding
- Work in pairs.
- Some Ss to retell the
main structure
grammar.
<b>Period 53 </b>
<b> </b>
<b> </b>
<b>I.Teaching points : By the end of the lesson,Ss will be able to grasp (su nam bat dc, su</b>
hieu thau.) knowledge they have learnt in the first semester and know how to
supplement( bo sung ) what they are short of (tru phi)
Ss will be able to practice all structure grammar from unit 1 to unit 8 .
- Develop Ss’ four skills.
<b>II. Preparation: -Text books, lesson plan, posters .</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up: </b>
-Asks Ss to retell the new words and read again the dialogue.
- Two others to retell the main structure grammar .
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
***
I/
**
**
II
***
<b>* Warm up : Chatting about daily routine</b>
<b>*/ Consolidation : </b>
1. Grammar
- Ask Ss to repeat the tenses they have learnt in the first
semester and write on the board
1.1. The tenses :
- Present Simple / - Past simple
- Present progressive / - Present perfect
- Simple future
1.2. The form of the verbs
- Modal verbs : can , could , may might
- Gerund ( V- ing ) => used after some verbs such as like
/ dislike / hate / love / enjoy and prepositions
- Have Ss to repeat and copy , then give examples with
each one .
2. Exercises :
- Using the posters with some exercises to show .
+ Ex 5 / 46 ( workbook ) : Past simple or Present perfect
- Ask Ss to work in pairs
- Call on some pairs to practice in front of lass
- Ask some Ss to go to the board to write them on the
board
- Give feedback
1.2 Comparison
Play game
Repeat the tenses they
have learnt .
Listen and copy , then
give some more
examples
Listen and copy
Repeat and copy .
Work in pairs to the
exercises and exchange
2.
***
IV/
V/
- Comparative
- Superlative
- Like
- (not) as …….. as
- (not) the same as
- different form
1.2 Direct and indirect speech
- Commands
- Requests
- Advice
=> S + told + O +(not) to + V …..
2. Exercises :
- Ex 7 / 48 ( workbook ) : Comparison
- Ex 3 / 33 ( workbook ) / Ex 6/ 51 ( workbook )
+ Have Ss work in pairs to do all the exercises
+ Call on some pairs to practice in front of class
<b>Consolidation: </b>
- Retel the main points of some Structure grammar .
<b>Homework : </b>
1. Redo all the exercises and copy
2. Prepare the test :
- Complete these sentences with the suitable words or
phrases in the brackets .
- Complete the conversation
- Read the passage carefully , then answer the questions
below
- Supply the correct tense form of the verb in the
brackets
- Listening comprehension
friends .
Listen and copy
Repeat and give some
more examples
Work in pairs
Demonstrate in front of
class .
Copy down
<b>Period 54</b>
<i><b> </b></i>
<b> </b><i><b>……… </b></i><b>..</b>
<b>I. The aims and requests: </b>
- By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to know what they would do in the situations
which require first - aid.
<b>II. Preparation: </b>
+ Teacher’spreparation:Textbooks , cassette , chalks , boards, posters , lesson plan.
+ Ss’ preparation: textbook, workbook, pen…
<b>III.Procedures: </b>
<b>1. Organizaton (1 )</b>’ - Greeting and checking attendance.
<b>2. Checking up: - Ask Ss to go to the board to do Ex L.f 5-p.79.</b>
* Form of checking: Speaking.
- T corrects and gives them marks.
<b>3. New lesson: </b>
<b>Time</b> <b> Teacher s activities</b>’ <b>Ss activitives</b>’
<b>***</b>
<b>***</b>
<i><b>* Warm up : Kim</b><b>,</b><b><sub>s game</sub></b><b><sub> ( Getting started )</sub></b></i>
- Ask Ss to open their books and look at the things
on page 80 for 20 seconds . Tell them these things
are often used for first - aid
- Divide the class into two groups .
- Tell them the group having the most right English
words is the winner .
- Have them open the books again and go through
the words in English .
<i>* Suggested answers :</i>
1. emergency room 2. sterile dressing
3. medicated oil 4. ice 5. water pack 6. alcohol
Whole class
Team work
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>V/</b>
<b>VI/</b>
- Have them discuss and write down what they
would do in these situations which require first –
aid
<i>Possible answers : </i>
+ A girl has a burn on her arm -> Use cold water /
ice to ease the pain
+ A boy has a bad cut on his leg -> Use alcohol /
medicated oil / sterile dressing
+ A girl has a nose bleed -> Use a handkerchief to
stop the bleeding / tell her to lie down .
+ A boy has a bee sting -> Use medicated oil …
<b>*Pre- reading : Introduce the topic of the passage </b>
reading and some new words .
<i>+ Pre teach (Vocabulary ): </i>
- First- aid: (n) So cuu.
- (an) ambulance : xe cuu thuong (Pic)
- (an) emergence = cap cuu , tinh trang khan cap
- unconscious (adj) > < conscious (adj) tinh tao
-( to) bleed : chay mau.
- Sterile dressing (n) : gac vo trung .
-> Ask Ss to copy the vocabulary in their notebooks
<b>* Checking technique: * Slap the board </b>
<i>( Put the new words in Vietnamese on the board )</i>
<i>* Gap filling Prediction </i>
- Hang the chart with the paragraph on the board .
<i><b> There was an emergency at Lan</b><b>,</b><b><sub>s school . A </sub></b></i>
<i><b>student …..(1)…. off her bike and hit her head on </b></i>
<i><b>the road . She was …..(2)…. but she cut her head </b></i>
<i><b>and the …….(3)…. was ……(4)….. badly . Lan </b></i>
<i><b>telephoned Bach Mai Hospital and asked the </b></i>
<i><b>nurse to send an ……(5)….. to Quang Trung </b></i>
<i><b>School . Lan was asked to keep the student …..(6)</b></i>
<i><b>…. while waiting for the ambulance . </b></i>
- Ask Ss to predict the words in the gaps
<b>* While - reading : </b>
- Have Ss open their books , listen to the tape while
reading the dialogue , then check their predictions
- Give feedback 1. fell 2. conscious 3. cut
4. bleeding 5. ambulance 6. awake
<i>* Comprehension questions </i>
- Ask Ss to read the dialogue again and select the
topic covered in the dialogue .
- Have Ss work in groups to write their answers on a
sheet of paper and hand in after finishing .
- Collect Ss ,<sub> papers and give feedback : a- b- c- e- f</sub>
<b>* Language focus 2 : - Revision the Future </b>
<b>simple</b>
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to complete the dialogue
and exchange their roles.
- Call on some pairs to practice in front of class .
- Give feedback :
<i>1. will 2. will 3. won,<sub>t , 4. Shall 5. will 6. </sub>,<sub> ll</sub></i>
<b>* Post - reading : </b>
Group work of 4/5 Ss
-Some groups to give
their answers and
correct
- Copy down new
lesson.
- Repeat in chorus.
T – Ss
Whole class
Team work
- Ss to go to the board
and write their words.
Individual work
T – Ss
Groupwork of 4/5 Ss
T – Ss
Pair work
- Ss to write a story
using the information
from the dialogue .
<i>*Role play : - Have Ss in turn play the roles to </i>
demonstrate the dialogue .
<i><b>* Write - it -up :</b><b> Ask Ss to write a story using the </b></i>
information from the dialogue .
- Tell Ss to begin their story with :
“ Yesterday there was an emergency at ……. “
- Monitor and help Ss with their work .
<b>* Consolidation: - Retell the main points .</b>
<b>* Homework : - Learn by heart new words.</b>
Let Ss do the exercises in the workbook (1,2 / 55 ).
Individual work
- Retell the main
points.
- Listen and copy
down homeworks.
<b>Period 56 </b>
<b>lesson 2</b>
<b>I. Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to make and respond to </b>
requests , offers , and promises.
- Develop Ss’ speaking skill.
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbooks , cassette , chalks , poster, lesson plan, CD.</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up : - Asks Ss go to the board to write the names of the things they have </b>
just seen from memory .
=> T corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson :</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>a.</b>
<b>b.</b>
<b>c.</b>
<b>+</b>
<b>+</b>
<b>● Warm up : * Net work </b>
*
<i>Possible answers : </i>
- have a snake bite / have a burn / have a cut /
have a bee sting / have a nose bleed ...
<b>*Pre - speaking : Introduce the topic of the </b>
speaking and some models sentences .
* Set the scene :
- Ask Ss some questions to elicit the models
<b>a. I want you to get me a bandage. How can I say? </b>
<b>b. I would like you to come to my party. How can I </b>
say?
<b>c. I tell my mother that I will surely finish my work </b>
before bedtime . How can I say ?
- Have Ss repeat 2 or 3 times before writing them on
the board ( underline the key words )
a. Will you ( please ) get me a bandage ?
b. Would you like to come to my party ?
c. I promise I will finish my homework before
Group work of 8 – 10
students
- Ss some questions to
elicit the models
- Ss repeat 2 or 3 times
before writing them on
the board ( underline
the key words )
- Ss to work out the
rules for themselves by
asking questions
T- Ss
<b>1.1</b>
<b>1.2</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>III/</b>
**
bedtime .
=> Concept checking
- Get Ss to work out the rules for themselves by
asking questions .
- After formulating the model sentences , elicit some
more phrases with the same use from students .
*
<i><b> To make a request : </b></i>
<b>Would /can / could / Will + you (please) + V…? </b>
<i>*Reponses : </i>
<b>+ Sure / Ok / All right . </b>
<b>- I am sorry . I can / I am afraid not </b>
<i><b>* To make an offer </b></i>
<b>Will / Won,<sub>t you </sub></b>
<b> Shall I / can I + V …..?</b>
<b> Can I </b>
<b>Would you like + to + V …...? </b>
<b>What can I do / get for you ? </b>
<b>Can I get you ………..? </b>
<i><b>*Responses</b><b> : </b><b> </b></i>
<b>+ Yes , please . / That would be nice . </b>
<b>- No , thank you . </b>
1.3 To make a promise
<b>I promise I will / I will not ………..</b>
<b>I will ………... I promise .</b>
<b>I promise to …………...</b>
<i><b>*Reponses : </b></i>
<b>I hope . / Good . / I am glad . / Do not forget</b>
- Ask Ss to copy down .
<b>* While - speaking : </b>
<b>+ Matching : </b>
- Hang the chart with the statements on the board .
- Ask Ss to look at the pictures ( page 82 ) and match
the situations with the statements .
1. The girl has a burn on her hand .
2. The girl has a bad fever .
3. The boy has just broken the vase .
4. The boy has a headache .
5. The boy has a snake bite .
- Give feedback : 1.a 2. d 3. e 4. b 5. c
<b>*Picture Drill : </b>
- Identify the situations in the pictures
Picture a) -> request
“ b) -> offer / request
“ c) -> offer / request
“ d) -> offer
“ e) -> promise
- Ask Ss to work in pairs
+ Model : Could you give me a bandage , please ?
Sure . Here you are
- Call on some pairs to demonstrate the exchanges in
front of class.
<b>* Post - speaking : </b>
Pair work ( closed pairs )
- Pairs work
T – Ss
- T – Ss
- Pairs work
Ss to copy down
Ss to look at the
pictures ( page 82 )
and match the
situations with the
statements .
Whole class
Group work of 4 / 5 Ss
Ss to work in pairs
- Some pairs to
demonstrate the
exchanges in front of
class .
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
- Get Ss in turn to practice all the exchanges
- Monitor and correct , encourage Ss to make
sentences for themselves
- Collect their ideas and write them on the boards
<i>* Suggested answers : </i>
b. A : Can I get you some water / medicine ?
B : Yes, please .
c. A : Can I get you some bandage ?
B : That would be nice
d. A : You must have a fever . Can I get you some
medicine / water ?
B : No , I am fine . Thank you .
e. A : I promise I will not play soccer in the house
again.
B : I hope so .
<b>* Language focus 3 + 4 :</b>
<b>● Making requests , offers and promises with will</b>
<b>Ex 3: Making requests , offers and promises with</b>
<b>will :- Explain the aims of the exercise </b>
- Ask Ss to read each situation and work in pairs to
complete the dialogue.
- Give feedback :
a. Will you open the window , please , Nga ?
b . will you give it to me , please ?
<b>Ex 4 : Work with a partner </b>
- Explain the aims of the exercise
- Ask Ss to read the example aloud .
- Have Ss work in pairs to make requests , offers or
promises
- Give feedback
b. Will you paint the door , please ?
I will paint the door tomorrow .
c . Will you study harder , please ?
I will study harder .
d. Will you carry the bag for me , please ?
Shall I carry the bag for you ?
e. Will you hang the washing , please ?
Shall I hang the washing for you ?
f. Will you cut the grass , please ?
<b>* Consolidation: - Retell the main points.</b>
<b>* Homework : </b>
1. Do exercise 3, 4/ 56 ( workbook )
2. Prepare the next lesson .
- Ss in turn to practice
all the exchanges.
- Ss to make sentences
for themselves.
- T – Ss
Pair work
-Some pairs to practice
in front of class .
- Ss to read all the
words in the box . Be
sure Ss to understand
the meaning of them
and each situation .
- Some pairs to read
their answers aloud .
- Retell the main
points.
- Listen and copy
down homeworks.
<b>Period 57.</b>
<b>Lesson 3</b>
<b>I. Teaching points: By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to know how to listen for </b>
details about the activities talking place in an emergency room .
<b>II. Teaching aids : Text books , cassette , chalks , boards , lesson plan. </b>
<b>B/ Steps of the lesson:</b>
<b>I . Organization: </b>
- Greeting and checking attendance.
<b>II. Checking up:</b>
Two Ss go to the board to make the similar dialogue about to send a letter or parcel.
- T corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
Page 104 School year : 2010- 2011
I/
1.
2.
II/
1.
2.
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
III/
- Ask Ss to look at the picture and write out all the
verbs describing the actions of the people in it .
- Tell Ss the group having the most right verbs is the
winner .
<i>- Give feedback : to drive , wheel / move / push , </i>
<i>weight , wait , lie , stand , lean . </i>
= > Lead in the new lesson
<b>*Pre- listening : Introduce the topic of the listening </b>
and some new words
* Pre teach vocabulary :
- an eye chart ( using picture ) -> eye sight
- a parademic : he takes care of patients but he is not
a doctor nor a nurse
- a wheelchair ( using the picture )
-> to wheel ( to push a wheel chair )
- a stretcher ( picture )
- a crutch -> crutches ( picture )
-> Have Ss copy
<b>* Checking technique : What and where </b>
* Matching :
- Ask Ss to look at the picture in their books again
and match the letter A,B ,C ,D ,E ,F to the correct
words in the box .
- Call on some volunteers from each group to
demonstrate in front of class .
- Give feedback
A -> ambulance D -> eye chart
* Order Prediction
- Rub out the letter ( A ,B …) but leave the words .
- Put the words in the table
Guess key
ambulance
wheelchair
crutches
eye chart
scale
stretcher
3
2
6
4
5
1
- Have Ss copy and guess the order of the words
- Play the tape and ash Ss to listen
- Ask Ss to give their answers and correct
*. True / False statements
- Stick the chart with the statements on the board :
+ A doctor is wheeling a patient into the emergency
+ The patient,<sub>s head is bandaged</sub>
+ A nurse is pushing a wheelchair with a patient
sitting on it .
+ The eye chart consists of 28 letters ranging in the
different size .
+ The baby,<sub>s mother is trying to stop the nurse from </sub>
weighing her baby .
- Ask Ss to read the statements carefully and check
if they understand the meaning of the statements
- Have Ss work in pairs to decide which of the
statements is true and which is false .
- Play the tape and have Ss listen ( 2 or 3 times )
- Call on Ss to read their answers and give feedback
Group work 0f 4/5 Ss
Ss the group having
the most right verbs is
the winner .
- Listen to and copy
down new lesson.
-Repeat in chorus.
T – Ss
Ss copy down.
- Ss to look at the
picture in their books
again and match the
letter A,B ,C ,D ,E ,F
to the correct words in
the box .
T- Ss / individual work
Ss are going to listen
to a paragraph about
the activities taking
place in an emergency
room which contains
the words on the board
Groupwork of 4/5 Ss
Ss copy and guess the
order of the words
Whole class
- Ss to read the
statements carefully
and check if they
understand the
meaning of the
statements
<b>Period 58. </b>
<b>lesson 4 </b>
<b>I . Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to read for the </b>
instructions about some more situations requiring first – aid . Ss will be able to know
<i><b>how to use “ in order to , so as to .</b></i>”
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbooks , poster , cassette , CD, lesson plan, chart , picture / </b>
drawing , mimes , 4 cardboards .
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up :- Asks Ss to go to the board to retell the main structure grammar of </b>
last lesson. And then T corrects and give them marks.
III. New lesson:
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>● Warm up : * Bingo </b>
- Ask Ss to give nouns for emergencies which
require first – aid and write them on the board
( burn , cut , bee sting , snake bite , fainting , shock ,
nose bleed )
- Have Ss choose 4 any 4 words on the board and
write them down on a piece of paper .
- call out the words until someone has ticked all the
four words and shouts “ Bingo “
<b>* Pre </b>–<b> reading</b> : Introduce the topic of reading
passage and some new words to Ss .
1. Pre – teach vocabulary :
-(to) lie flat : ( mime / drawing )
<b>* Checking technique : Rub out and remember</b>
* Network
- Draw the network with some examples on the
board
- Ask Ss to think of what to do in these emergency
cases
- Collect and write the students, <sub>ideas on the bard </sub>
<b>* While </b>–<b> reading</b> :
- Have Ss open their books and read the instructions
page 83
* Matching :
Whole class
Ss choose 4 any 4 words
on the board and write
them down on a piece of
paper .
Individual
- `Have Ss copy down.
Repeat in chorus.
T – Ss
- Ss to think of what to
do in these emergency
cases.
Whole class
- Ss to go to the board
and add the missing
information .
Individual
Page 105 School year : 2010- 2011
Shock
<b>III/</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
- Ask Ss to read the statements / page 84 and match
tree Leadings A , B , C to them .
Give feedback A -> a , c , e B -> b C -> d
* Grid : - Draw the grid on the board .
- Ask Ss to read the instructions again and fill the
information .
- Call on some Ss to the board to write their answers
- Give feedback
Cases Do Don,<sub>t</sub>
Fainting
- Leave the patient
lying flat .
- Elevate the patients,
feet or lower his / her
head .
- Do not force
him / her to sit
or stand .
Shock
- Give him / her a
- Do not
overheat the
victim with
blankets or coat
- Do not give the
victim any food
or drink or drug .
Burns
- Cool the burn
immediately to
minimize the tissue
damage .
- Put the affected
part under a running
cold tap .
- Ease the pain with
ice or cold water
packs .
- Cover the burned
area with a thick
sterile dressing .
- Have Ss copy the grid in their notebooks .
<b>* Post </b>–<b> reading</b> :
- Ask Ss to work in groups to continue discussing
how to give first aid . And Call on some volunteers
from each group to demonstrate in front of class .
<b>* Language focus 1: + Negative purposes : </b>
<i><b>* In order( not) to +V../ *So as (not) to +V..</b></i>
Eg : You have to take your warm clothes with you in
order not to get bad cold.
<b>* Matching : Ex 1.</b>
- Ask Ss to read the example aloud and ask them to
match one part of a sentence from column A with
another part in column B
- Call on some Ss to read their answers and give
feedback
<b> 1- f , 2- c , 3- b , 4 </b>–<b> e , 5- a , 6- d</b>
<b>* Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>* Homework : </b>
1. Let Ss do the exercises 6,7 in the workbook .
- Ss to read the
instructions again and
fill the information .
- Some Ss to the board to
write their answers
Individual
Pair work
Group work .
- Some volunteers from
each group to
demonstrate in front of
class .
Ss to exchange their
answers to correct for
each other .
- Retell the main points
2. Prepare the next lesson .
<b>Period 59.</b>
<b>lesson 5</b>
Develop Ss’ Writing skill.
<b>II. Teaching aids : Text book , chalk , boards, posters, lesson plan,pictures.</b>
***
I/
1.
<b>* Warm up : Shark attack </b>
( Revised words : lie flat , elevate , lower , victim ,
ease )
Lead in the new lesson .
<b>* Pre </b>–<b> writing</b> : Introduce the topic of the writing
and some new words to Ss
*. Pre- teach vocabulary :
- disease (adj) mac benh , (n) benh cua co the .
- gloomy ( adj) toi tam , u am , am dam.
- Get on together : song hoa thuan voi ai.
-( to) thank Sb for sth
Eg : She thanked me for helping her
- (to )cheer Sb up = to make Sb feel happier : co vu,
chia se
T- Ss
T- Ss
2.
3.
- (to come over ( translation )
+ (an ) Occasion : dip gi…
+ (to) contact : lien he, tiep xuc.
Have Ss copy
<b>* Checking technique : slap the board </b>
*. Set the scene
- Ask Ss to close their books and listen “ Nga was sick
and she had to go to the hospital . After she left the
hospital , she wrote a thank – you note to Hoa . Why
and what did she write ? “
<b>*. True / False Predictions </b>
- Hang the poster with the statements on the board
+. Nga writes to thank Hoa for some come candy .
+. Hoa,<sub>s gift cheered Nga up .</sub>
+ Nga ,<sub>d like Hoa to see her at the hospital .</sub>
+. Nga is very bored now .
Whole class
S- Ss to close their
books and listen “ Nga
was sick and she had
- Ss to read the
statements and predict
*
II/
III/
IV/
V/
+. Nga writes the letter at the hospital .
- Ask Ss to read the statements and predict .
- Get S to give their predictions and write them on the
board .
- Ask Ss to look at the letter and complete it with the
right verb forms .
- Monitor and help Ss with the tense forms .
- Call on some Ss to give their answers and give
feedback .
- Ask Ss to read the whole letter and check if their
prediction are right or not .
<b>* Answer key : </b>
1. False -> flower ( not candy ) 2. True
3. False -> at her house ( not at the hospital )
4. True
5. False -> at her house ( not at the hospital )
<b>* While </b>–<b> writing :</b><i><b> Questions and answers </b></i>
- Tell Ss they are going to write a thank – you note to
a friend and invite him / her to go on a picnic with
them .
- Ask Ss to read the questions carefully to answer
orally
- Have Ss practice speaking to each other .
- Monitor and correct .
- Get Ss to join the sentences into a paragraph to make
it a thank – you note .
- Tell Ss to write their letters in their exercise
notebooks .
<b>* Post </b>–<b> writing</b><i><b> : Exhibition </b></i>
- Divide the class into 4 groups and choose a letter
randomly in each group .
- Compare their letters and correct .
- Call on some more Ss to read their letters for class
- Give feedback and correct .
<b>* Consolidation: </b>
- Retell the main pointsof this lesson.
<b>* Homework : </b>
1. Ask Ss to use the same format to write another letter
to another friend for another occasion .
2. Do the exercises in the workbook .
Individual
Individual
- Ss to read the whole
letter and check if
their prediction are
right or not .
T – Ss
- Ss to join the
sentences into a
paragraph to make it a
T – Ss
Groupwork
- Compare their letters
and correct
Individual
- Some more Ss to read
their letters for class
- Retell the main
points .
- Copy down
homeworks.
<b>Period 60 .</b>
<b>I. The aims and requests </b>
<b>* Teaching points: By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to </b>know what they
should do to protect the environment and save natural resources . They will also be
<b>able to understand the structure: S + to be + adj + that – clause.</b>
<i>- Developing Skills: listening, reading, speaking.</i>
<b>II .Preparation: + T:Textbooks , cassette, posters , lesson plan ,6 flashcards , a chart.</b>
+ Ss: textbook, notebook, pen…
<b>III. Steps of the lesson: </b>
<b>1. Organizaton: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
- Ask: Who’s absent to day?
<b>2. Checking up: </b>
*Qs: - Ask Ss to speak the vocabulary period 59.
* Form of checking: speaking.
* T. corrects and give them marks.
<b>3. New lesson: </b>
<b>Teacher’s activities</b> <b>T</b> <b>Students’ activities</b>
<b>* Warm up: getting started _ p.89</b>
- Set the scene: Play the song 3R
+ What’s the title of the song?
Phân loại rac để làm gì? (Tái chế) đó
là chủ đề của bài học hơm nay và các
em sẽ hiểu rõ hơn 3R nghĩa là gì.
*Matching:
- Show 4 pictures.
<b>- Explain the words: Use cloth bags,</b>
use tree leaves to wrap things, make
garbage into fertilizer, make vegetable
matter into animal food…
- Ask students to match the words
with the pictures.
<b>- Ask students to work in pairs:</b>
A: We should use ...
B: Yes, that ‘s right.
A.
<b> Preteach vocabulary ;</b>
5’
10’
<b> - Listen to the song. </b>
- Answer.
- Listen and repeat then
translate.
- Listen and repeat
- Listen and repeat
- Copy
- Match
<b>work in pairs</b>
- Listen
Sts: listen to the tape while
reading the dialogue.
Sts: practice the dialogue
T: present new words
New words
-(to) recycle: tái chế (Situation)
-(to) contact: liên lạc
(Translation)
-(to) overpackage: gói kỹ (Situation)
- <b>Check by matching.</b>
<b>B.Presentation the dialogue: Listen</b>
<b>and read P.89. </b>
T: Set the scene: <b> Miss Blake</b>
A representative from Friends of
the Earth, Miss Blake, is talking to the
students of Quang Trung school.
Friends of the Earth shows people
how to protect the environment and
save natural resources
True/False predictions
1. Friends of the Earth is an
2. Miss Blake asks the students to
remember 3 things: reduce, reuse,
recycle.
3. We cannot reuse things like
envelopes, glass, plastic bottles and
old plastic bags.
4. Miss Blake says that we should
use cloth bags.
<i><b>- Ask sts to predict</b></i>
<i><b>- T gets feeback1..</b></i>
<i><b>- Plays the tape and ask sts to check</b></i>
<i><b>the prediction. </b></i>
<b>- Getfeedback 2.</b>
10’
( pairs)
-Read through the
statements
-Predict True or False
-Listen and read the
dialogue
Sts: listen to the tape check
T or F.
-read aloud.
-Read the dialogue for
more details amd find the
answers
<b>- Call some group read aloud.</b>
<b>- Show the questions.</b>
<b>* Comprehension questions</b>
a, What does Miss Blake mean by
<i>reduce?</i>
<i>b, What things can we reuse?</i>
<i>c, What does recycle mean?</i>
d, Where can we look for information
on recycling things?
<b>Answer key:</b>
a/ Reduce means not buying product
which are overpackaged
b/ We can reuse things like envelopes,
glass, plastic bottles and old plastic
bags
c/ Recycle means not just throwing
things away. Try and find another
use for them.
d/ We can look for information on
recycle things by having a contact
with an organization like Friends of
the Earth, going to the local library,
or asking your family and friends or
scientific society.
<b>. Give model sentences:</b>
<i><b>I am pleased that you want to</b></i>
<i><b>know more</b></i>
- Have Sts read again in choral
and individual.
. Concept check:
- Meaning:
- <b>Form: S + tobe + adj + that –</b>
<b>clause.</b>
- Use: Adj followed by a noun
clause
<b>C. </b>
Practice
10’
7’
- Find the sentence
from the dialogue.
- Read in choral then
individual.
- Translate the model
sentences.
- Make sentences
from the cues
- Read aloud
- Work individually
- Copy the form
- Practice in pairs
<b>- Give the cues</b>
|<b>She / happy / I passed my</b>
<b>exam.</b>
|<b> They / sure / he will come</b>
<b>here.</b>
|<b> It / good / we reduce the</b>
<b>garbage.</b>
<b>4. Consolidation (5’)</b>
<b>- Shows the picture: 3R</b>
- Ask Sts to retell the meaning of 3
<b>word: 3R and the form.</b>
<b>5. Homework (5’)</b>
- Learn by heart new words and
form;
- Write 3 sentences using the cues
and the new form.
3’
2’ - Retell the main points of
this lesson.
- Copy down homeworks
<b>Period 60 .</b>
*** <i><b>*Warm up : Brainstorming (Getting started) </b></i>
Reuse plastic bags
Group work of 4/5 teams
I/
1.
**
2.
*
*
*
*
*
*
- Ask Ss to think of ways to reduce the amount of
garbage they produce .
- Deliver posters to Ss , dividing them into 4 groups
- Tell Ss to put the posters on the board after they finish
and the team having the most good ideas is the winner .
- Give feedback
( Use cloth bags , use tree leaves to wrap things , make
garbage into fertilizer , make vegetable matter into
animal food … )
Lead in to new lesson .
<b> Pre </b>–<b> reading</b> : Introduce the topic of the passage
reading and some new words to Ss .
* Pre – teach vocabulary :
- representative (n) = dai dien
- to protect = to keep so/ sth safe from danger .
-> to protect so / sth from so / sth
- natural resource (n) : coal mines , oil / gold / mineral
deposits
- to recycle “ to make sth already used able to be used
again .
- to contact = to communicate with so by telephone or
letter .
-> Have Ss copy .
<b>* Checking technique : Jumbled words </b>
- Stick 6 flashcards with jumbled words on the board
- Ask Ss to rewrite the words in the right order .
- Tell Ss the first two groups with right words will get 2
points .
- Correct and give feedback
contact – representative – resource
natural – protect – recycle
<b>*True / false predictions </b>
<i>- Set the scene “ A representative from Friends of the </i>
<i>Earth , Miss Blake , is talking to the students of Quang </i>
<i>Trung School . Friends of the Earth shows people how to</i>
<i>protect the environment and save natural resources “ </i>
- Put the chart with the statements on the board .
1. Friends of the Earth is an organization to help
people make friends with each other .
2. Miss Blake asks the students to remember 3 things
3. Reduce means buying the products which are over
packed .
4. We can not reuse things like envelopes , glass ,
plastic bottles , old plastic bags .
5. Miss Blake says that we should use cloth bags and
.
- Ss to think of ways to
reduce the amount of
garbage they produce .
- Ss to put the posters on
the board after they
finish and the team
having the most good
ideas is the winner .
- Copy down new
lesson.
Individual
Teacher – Ss
Whole class
Group work of 4/5 Ss
- Put the chart with the
statements on the board.
Ss to work in pairs to
decide if the statements
are true or false .
Page 113 School year : 2010- 2011
tconatc psentreretive
a ceresoru
II/
1.
2.
III/
IV/
V/
should not use plastic bags at all .
6. Recycling means not just throwing things away
but trying and finding another use for them .
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to decide if the statements are
- Call on some Ss to read their guesses and write them on
the board .
While – reading :
*. Checking predictions
- Ask Ss to open their books , listen to the tape while
reading the dialogue .
- Call on Ss to correct the false statements .
- Give feedback
1. False -> an organization to help people
2. True
3. False -> Reduce means not buying …
4. False -> We can reuse things …
5. True 6. True
* Comprehension questions :
- Ask Ss to look at the questions and work in pairs .
- Monitor and help Ss with their work
- Call on some pairs to practice asking and answering the
questions .
- Give feedback
<i>a. Reduce means not buying products which are over </i>
<i>packed . </i>
<i>b. We can reuse things like envelopes , glass , plastic </i>
<i>bottles and old plastic bags . </i>
<i>c. Recycle means not just throwing things away . Try and</i>
<i>find another use for them . </i>
<i>d. We can look for information on recycling things by </i>
<i>having a contact with an organization like Friends of the</i>
<i>Earth , going to the local library or asking your family </i>
<i>and friends . </i>
<i>e. We should not use plastic bags because when we </i>
<i>throw them away , they could stay very long and could </i>
<i>not be self- destroyed . </i>
<b>* Post </b>–<b> reading : * Discussion </b>
<i><b>How to protect our environment ?</b></i>
“ ”
- Ask Ss to express their opinions / ideas on this topic .
- Write their ideas on the board into a list
- Give feedback , correct and hove them copy .
<b>* Consolidation:</b>
-Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>*Homework : </b>
1. Write the questions and full answers in your exercise
notebook .
2. Do the exercises ( 1,2 ) in the Workbook .
some Ss to read their
guesses and write them
on the board .
Teacher – Ss
Ss to look at the
questions and work in
pairs .
Pair work
Individual
Whole class
Ss to express their
opinions / ideas on this
topic
Pair work
Individual
Some Ss Retell the main
points of this lesson.
Copy down homeworks
<b>Period 61</b>
<b>I. Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , </b>Ss will be able to practice giving and
responding to instructions and listening for specific information about making compost .
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbooks , cassette , chalks , poster, lesson plan, CD.</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up : - Asks Ss go to the board to write the names of the things they have </b>
just seen from memory .
=> T corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson :</b>
***
I/
1.
2.
II/
***
*
*
<b>*Warm up : Kim,<sub>s game </sub></b>
* Possible answers : Used paper , old newspapers ,
books , cardboard boxes , bottles , glasses , jars , plastic
bags , food cans , drinking tins , vegetable matter ,
clothes , shoes , school bags …
<b>* Speak </b>
<b>* / Pre- speaking : Introduce the topic of the speaking </b>
and some new words to students .
* Pre-teach vocabulary :
- Fertilizer (n) : Farmer often use this thing to make their
plants or trees grow well .
-> to fertilize
- Compost (n) : What do you call the fertilizer made
from spoiled food , leaves , vegetable mater ?
-> compost heap
- Fabric (n) = material
- Leather (n) : What are the shoes made of ?
+ Have Ss copy in their notebooks .
<b>Checking technique : Bingo </b>
*Dictation list :
- Tell Ss they are going to listen to the words for items
and put them into the right groups .
- Draw the table on the words and put them in the right
columns .
- Model some words .
- Read the words aloud , slowly and jumble them up
- After listening , ask Ss to work in pairs and give their
answers .
- Read the words again and correct
<b>Group</b> <b>Items</b>
Paper used paper (old newspaper ,cardboard boxes
Glass ( bottles , glasses , jars )
Plastic (Plastic bags , plastic bottles )
Metal ( food cans , drinking tins ..)
Fabric Clothes ( cloth bags , material )
Leather ( shoes , sandals , schoolbags )
Vegetable
matter Fruit Peels ( vegetable , rotten fruits )
<b>*While </b>–<b> speaking</b> :
Mapped dialogue :
- Put the mapped dialogue chart on the board .
- Elicit the exchanges from students
- Have some pairs practice each exchange before going
on to another exchange .
- After fishing the dialogue , ask a good pair to
demonstrate the whole dialogue .
a. Open pairs :
- Ask some pairs to practice in front of class .
b. Closed pairs :
- Ask Ss to work in pairs , replacing the information with
the words in the dictation list
Whole class
Team work
Teacher – Ss
Individual
Individual
Pair work
Ss to work in pairs and
give their answers .
some pairs practice each
exchange before going
on to another exchange .
Teacher –Ss
Ss to work in pairs ,
replacing the
information with the
words in the dictation
III/
IV/
V/
- Monitor and correct .
A B
Which group ( do clothes )
belong to ?
What can we do with
( those clothes ) ?
Is / are ( fruit vegetable
matter ) ?
What will we do with
(it ) ?
Put ( them ) in fabric
We can ( recycle them and
make them into paper or
shopping bags .
That is right
We make ( it into compose
and fertilizer our field . )
<b>Post speaking :</b>
<b>*Listening </b>
Multiple choice :
- Tell Ss they are going to listen to an expert who gives
the instructions to make compost .
- Ask Ss to open their books and read the multiple
choice questions
- Have them guess the answers
- Turn on the tape 2 or 3 times , Ss listen and do the
exercise .
- Get Ss to give their answers and correct
Answers : a. A b. B c. A d. B
- Have them copy
<b>* Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>*Home work : </b>
1. Copy down the dialogue , replacing the information .
2. Do the exercises in the work book.
3. Prepare the next lesson .
list
Pair work
Ss to open their books
and read the multiple
choice questions
Individual
Some Ss Retell the main
points of this lesson.
Copy down homeworks
<b>Period 62.</b>
<b>I . Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to form the passive in the </b>
Present Simple
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbooks , poster , cassette , CD, lesson plan,word square chart . </b>
pictures , drawing .
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up :</b>
- Asks Ss to go to the board to retell the main structure grammar of last lesson.
-T corrects and give them marks.
Page 117 School year : 2010- 2011
I/
1.
**
2.
II/
1.
2.
<b>N</b> <b>B</b> <b>C</b> <b>G</b> <b>A</b> <b>R</b> <b>B</b> <b>A</b> <b>G</b> <b>E</b> <b>R</b>
<b>V</b> <b>E</b> <b>D</b> <b>R</b> <b>D</b> <b>O</b> <b>P</b> <b>P</b> <b>U</b> <b>R</b> <b>E</b>
<b>E</b> <b>J</b> <b>U</b> <b>E</b> <b>Y</b> <b>I</b> <b>L</b> <b>A</b> <b>R</b> <b>S</b> <b>C</b>
<b>L</b> <b>U</b> <b>S</b> <b>E</b> <b>D</b> <b>P</b> <b>A</b> <b>P</b> <b>E</b> <b>R</b> <b>Y</b>
<b>O</b> <b>S</b> <b>T</b> <b>N</b> <b>O</b> <b>T</b> <b>S</b> <b>E</b> <b>D</b> <b>E</b> <b>C</b>
<b>P</b> <b>R</b> <b>O</b> <b>T</b> <b>E</b> <b>C</b> <b>T</b> <b>R</b> <b>U</b> <b>U</b> <b>L</b>
<b>E</b> <b>A</b> <b>B</b> <b>R</b> <b>C</b> <b>A</b> <b>I</b> <b>B</b> <b>C</b> <b>S</b> <b>E</b>
<b>R</b> <b>E</b> <b>C</b> <b>E</b> <b>E</b> <b>N</b> <b>C</b> <b>A</b> <b>E</b> <b>E</b> <b>K</b>
<b>D</b> <b>E</b> <b>E</b> <b>E</b> <b>F</b> <b>G</b> <b>H</b> <b>G</b> <b>I</b> <b>J</b> <b>L</b>
- Tell Ss the topic about the environment and there are
12 hidden words .
- Divide the class into 4 groups .
- Ask Ss to write their answers on a piece of paper and
hand in when they finish
- Tell Ss the group with the most right words is the
winner .
Answer key :
environment , garbage , pure , used
paper , protect .
envelope , dust , green tree , can ,
plastic , paper bag ,
reduce , reuse , recycle
<b>* Pre </b>–<b> reading</b> :Introduce the topic of the passage
reading and some new words to students .
1. Pre- teach vocabulary :
- tire (n) : using picture
- pipe (n) : using drawing
- deposit (n) : khoan tien gui vao mot tai khoan
- to refill = to fill something empty again
- to melt >< to freeze
- Get Ss to copy in their notebooks .
<b>* Checking vocabulary : Rub out and remember </b>
*Open prediction
- Tell Ss they are going to read a page in a newspaper
giving some recycling facts to protect the environment .
- Ask them to look at the board and guess what they are
going to read .
+ What do people do with used things ?
+ What can they make from them ?
- Call on some Ss to read their guesses on the board
Car ties -> …………..
Milk bottles ->………
Glass -> …………..
Drink cans -> …………..
Household and garden waste -> ……… ….
<b>* While </b>–<b> reading</b> :
1. Grid
- Draw the grid on the board and have Ss copy it
- Ask Ss to open their books and read the text .
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to make a list of recycling facts
mentioned in the text .
- Call on some Ss to write the information in the grid on
the board .
Answer Key :
Used things Recycling Facts
Car tires
Milk bottles
Glass
Drink cans
Household and
garden waste
are recycled to make pipes and
floor recoverings
are cleaned and refilled
(with milk )
is broken up , melted and made
into new glassware
are brought back for recycling
is made into compost .
* Comprehension questions
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to answer the questions .
Ss the topic about the
environment and there
are 12 hidden words .
Group work of 4 teams
Ss to write their answers
on a piece of paper and
hand in when they finish
Ss the group with the
most right words is the
winner .
T – Ss
Whole class
Individual
Whole class
<b>Period 63</b>
<b>A / The aims : </b>
<b>I . Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , </b>Ss will be able to write a set of
instructions, using the sequencing .
Develop Ss’ Writing skill.
<b>II. Teaching aids : Text book , chalk , boards, posters, lesson plan,pictures.</b> drawing,
mime , picture
<b>B/ Steps of the lesson:</b>
<b>I. Organization: -Greeting and checking attendance .</b>
<b>II. Checking up:</b>
- Asks two Ss to answer the qs c-d in the book.
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
Page 119 School year : 2010- 2011
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
1. Lucky number
2. Say this sentence in he passive “ people speak
English everywhere “
3. Say this sentence in the active “ cartoons are liked
by most children “
4. Lucky number
5. Lucky number
6. Say this sentence in the passive “ We do not use
7. Say this sentence in the active “ Are candies liked
by the children ? “
8. Say this sentence in the passive “ Mr Han teaches
Maths . “
9. Say this sentence in the passive “ Vegetables do
not eat meat . “
- Divide the class into 2 teams .
<b>* Pre- writing : Introduce the topic of the writing and</b>
some new words to Ss
1. Pre-teach vocabulary :
- to soak : put sth in liquid for a time so that it
becomes completely wet .
- to mash : mime
- wire mesh (n) : luoi dien
- bucket (n) : drawing
-> Have Ss copy down .
<b>* Checking vocabulary : Slap the board </b>
*. Ordering prediction :
- Set the scene : tell Ss they are going to read a text
about how to recycle used paper .
- Put the verbs on the board randomly in a flow chart
- Ask Ss to work in groups to predict the order of the
actions
<b>soak dry pull out mix press mash </b>
1………. 2 ………. 3 ……..
4 ……… 5 ………. 6 …………
- Call on about 2 pairs to write their answers on the
board .
- Explain the process of recycling , using mimes or
Vietnamese and correct .
<b>- Feedback </b>
<b> 1. soak 2. mash 3. mix. 4. pull out 5. press 6. dry</b>
<b>III / While – writing : </b>
- Ask Ss to open their books , read the text and fill in
the verbs
- Monitor and correct the exercise in the text book .
- Feedback
<b>1. use 2. mix 3. place 4. press. 5.wrap 6. wait 7. dry</b>
Team work
Listen and copy
Teacher – Ss
Team work
Teacher
Group work of 4/ 5 Ss
Individual
Individual
Group work
<b>Period 64 .</b>
<b>I . Teaching points : </b>By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to form the passive in
Present simple / Future simple and structures with Adjectives .
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbooks , poster , lesson plan, chart , picture / drawing , mimes , </b>
4 cardboards .
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up :- Asks Ss to go to the board to retell the main structure grammar of </b>
last lesson. And then T corrects and give them marks.
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>Ex 1:</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>* Warm up : Questions game</b>
- Call on a student to go to the board and give him or
her a job name .
- Ask the rest of the class to guess the job by asking
yes-no questions
- The chosen student can only answer yes or no
- Do you get a big salary ?
- Do you wear uniform ?
<b>A/ Language focus </b>
<b>* The passive forms </b>
1. Passive Form in the Present Simple
S + am / is / are + past participle
=> It is used when the subject is affected by the action
of the verb .
*Work with a partner.
<b>LF 1-p.95 : Ordering pictures : </b>
+ Ask Ss to read the instructions and look at the
pictures to put them in the correct order according to
the instructions
+ Call on some groups to give their answers .
<b>+ Give feedback a.1 b.4 c.3 d.5 e.2 f.6 </b>
* Writing :
+ Ask Ss to rewrite the sentences in the passive form
Individual
Teacher – Ss
Pair work
Pair work
<b>Ex 3:</b>
<b>Ex 4:</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
the board and write their sentences
+ Correct and give feedback
<b>LF 2-p.96: Passive Form in the Future Simple </b>
<b>S + will / shall + be + past participle</b>
- Have Ss copy down
- Show Ss the questions ( o) and ask them to fill in
the gaps , using the Passive
- Call on Ss to give their answers and correct
2. Will … be built …..?
3. … will be finished …. 4.
Will … be made … ?
<b>*. Adjectives followed by an infinitive / a noun clause </b>
<b>2.1. It + be + adjective + to infinitive </b>
Example : It is very difficult to speak English well
*Complete the sentences
- Ask Ss to open their books and complete the dialogues
- Call on some pairs to demonstrate the dialogues and
correct
<b>2.2 . S + be + adj + that / noun clause </b>
Example : We are delighted that you passed the English
exam .
- Get Ss to copy .
*Complete the letter
- Ask Ss to read the letter and match the words .
A B Key
1. relieved (a)
2. Congratulation
a. xin chuc mung
b. trong cho
c. xac nhan lai
d. nhe nhom
1.d
2.a
3.b
4. c
- Ask Ss to copy the vocabulary
- Ask ss to work in pairs to complete the letter using the
words in the box
- Get some Ss to give their answers
- Give feedback and correct.
<b>* Exercises:</b>
0. are delighted
1. was happy
2. am relieved
3. is afraid
4. Are … sure …
Individual
Whole class
Pair work
Teacher – Ss
Whole class
Individual
Read the letter aloud
Listen and copy
5. am certain
- Call on some Ss to read the complete letter aloud .
<b>* Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>* Homework : </b>
1. Rewrite the letter beginning with : “ Nam,<sub>s </sub>
grandparents are delighted that he passed his English
exam ……”
2. Do the exercises in the workbook .
<b>Period 65 . </b>
<b> </b>
<b>I.Teaching points : By the end of the lesson,</b> Ss will be able to form the passive voice in
Present simple / Future simple and structures with Adjectives .
Ss will be able to practice all structure grammar and do exercises of unite 10.
- Develop Ss’ four skills.
<b>II. Preparation: -Text books, lesson plan, posters .</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up: </b>
-Asks Ss to retell the new words and read again the dialogue.
- Two others to retell the main structure grammar .
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>Ex 1:</b>
<b>* GRAMMAR:</b>
<b>* Passive Form in the present Simple: </b>
<b>S + am/ is / are + Past participle</b>
- It is used when the subject is affected by the action of the
verb .
- How to change an active sentence to a passive voice :
Active S V O
Passive S + be + PII by O
eg : I love you
You are loved by me
Have Ss copy
*Work with a partner
- Ordering pictures :
+ Ask Ss to read the instructions and look at the pictures to
put them in the correct order according to the instructions
+ Call on some groups to give their answers .
<b>+ Give feedback a.1 b.4 c.3 d.5 e.2 f.6 </b>
Individual
Teacher – Ss
Work with a partner
Pair work
- Ss to read the
instructions and look at
the pictures to put them
in the correct order
according to
<b>2.</b>
<b>Ex 3:</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>Ex 4:</b>
<b>Ex 4:</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>* Writing : </b>
+ Ask Ss to rewrite the sentences in the passive form
+ Let them compare their writing and ask Ss to go to the
+ Correct and give feedback
<b>1.2 Passive Form in the Future Simple </b>
<b>S + will / shall + be + past participle</b>
- Have Ss copy down
- Show Ss the questions ( o) and ask them to fill in the
gaps , using the Passive
- Call on Ss to give their answers and correct
1. … will be shown / 2. Will … be built …..?
3. … will be finished … 4. Will … be made … ?
<b>*. Adjectives followed by an infinitive / a noun clause </b>
<b>2.1. It + be + adjective + to infinitive </b>
Example : It is very difficult to speak English well
*Complete the sentences
- Ask Ss to open their books and complete the dialogues
- Call on some pairs to demonstrate the dialogues and
correct
|Give model sentences:
<i><b>I am pleased that you want to know more</b></i>
- Have Sts read again in choral and individual.
. Concept check:Meaning / Use / form…
- <b>Form: S + tobe + adj + that – clause.</b>
- Use: Adj followed by a noun clause
|She / happy / I passed my exam.
|<b> They / sure / he will come here.</b>
| It / good / we reduce the garbage.
<b>2.2 .(S + be + adj + that / noun clause )</b>
Example : We are delighted that you passed the English
exam .
- Get Ss to copy .
*Complete the letter
- Ask Ss to read the letter and match the words .
A B Key
1. relieved (a)
2. Congratulation
3. Look forward to(
4. confirm (v)
a. xin chuc mung
b. trong cho
c. xac nhan lai
d. nhe nhom
1.d
2.a
3.b
4. c
- Ask Ss to copy the vocabulary
- Ask ss to work in pairs to complete the letter using the
words in the box
- Get some Ss to give their answers
- Give feedback and correct.
- Call on some Ss to read the complete letter aloud .
<b>* Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>* Homework : </b>
1. Rewrite the letter beginning with : “ Nam,<sub>s grandparents</sub>
are delighted that he passed his English exam ……”
2. Do the exercises in the workbook .
form
Pair work
Teacher – Ss
Individual
Whole class
Pair work
Teacher – Ss
Whole class
Ss to read the letter and
match the words
Individual
Ss to give their answers
Read the letter aloud
Ss to read the complete
letter aloud
Listen and copy
ss to work in pairs to
complete the letter using
the words in the box
- Retell the main points
of this lesson.
- Copy down
homeworks.
<b>Period 66 .</b>
<b>I. Teaching points: By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to </b>use some expressions to
express their interest
<b>I . Teaching aids : Textbooks , cassette , chalks , boards, posters , lesson plan.</b>
<b>I. Organizaton: -Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up: - Ask Ss to go to the board to do Ex L.f 3.</b>
- T. corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson: </b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>a.</b>
<b>b.</b>
<b>c.</b>
<b>d.</b>
<b>e.</b>
<b>* Warm up : Jumbled words </b>
- Write the topic “ Places of interest “ on the board
Ha long bay Nha Rong harbor
- Ask each team to connect the words to make the right
phrases for places of interest and write them on the
board as fast as possible
=> Ngo Mon Gate , Ha long Bay , The Temple
Literature , Nha rong Harbor .
<b>* Getting Started : </b>
- Ask Ss to open their books and match the names with
the pictures
- Call on some Ss to give their answers
a. Ngo Mon Gate b. Na rong Harbor
d. Ha Long Bay
- Call some Ss to read the proper names aloud .
<b>* Pre- reading : Introduce the topic of the passage </b>
reading and some new words to students .
*. Pre- teach Vocabulary :
- Crop (n) : something such as grain , rice , fruit … is
grown in one season .
- Sugar cane (n) : cay mia ( It is used to make sugar )
- Water buffalo (n) : con trau
- forty – minute drive : The drive takes 40 minutes
Form : A / an Adj ( number ) – N + N
Ex : a3 – month vacation / a thirteen – year – old – boy
Team work
Watch EL TV
Individual
Listen and copy
Teacher – Ss
individual and choral
Whole class
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V./</b>
<b>VI/</b>
<b>* Checking vocabulary : Bingo </b>
+. Guiding questions :
- Set the scene and put the chart with questions on the
board
a. where does Hoa meet The Jones ?
b. Is it the first time The Jones have visited Viet Nam?
c. How do they travel to Ha Noi ?
d. What do they see along the road to Ha Noi ?
e. What would Tim like to do ?
- Ask Ss to think about the questions in a few minutes
- Have Ss listen to the tape while reading the dialogue
- Feedback :
a. Hoa meets The Jones at the airport
b. Yes , it is . c. By taxi
d. They see a boy riding a water buffalo , rice paddies ,
corn and sugar cane fields
e. He would like to take a photo .
<b>* While – reading : </b>
- Ask Ss to listen to the tape and say out True or False
- Read the sentences aloud and call on some Ss to answer
, then have them correct the false sentences and get them
to write in their notebooks .
a. T b. T d. T e . T
c. F -> … in a taxi
f. F -> … Not only rice and corn but also sugar canes are
grown around Ha Noi .
- Call on some groups of five to practice the dialogue in
front of class
- Correct their pronunciation
<b>* Post – reading : Discussion </b>
- Ask Ss to read the dialogue again , discuss with them
and ask them to pick out the sentences containing the
situations mentioned below .
* to express interest :
- I,<sub>d like you to meet my parents ….</sub>
- It is nice to meet you ….
- It is great to be in Viet Nam .
- I would to sit with Tim …..
* to express a request :
- Would you mind sitting in the front seat …
Individual
Pair work
Ss to think about the
questions in a few
minutes
Ss listen to the tape
while reading the
dialogue
Ss to work in pairs to
Whole class
Ss to listen to the tape
and say out True or
False
some groups of five to
practice the dialogue
in front of class
Individual
Ss to read the
dialogue again ,
discuss with them and
ask them to pick out
the sentences
containing the
situations mentioned
below .
Individual
- Retell the main
- Would you mind if I took a photo ?
<b>* Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>*/ Homework : </b>
1. Learn by heart new words and some structures to give
some examples .
2. Do the exercises in the workbooks .
points of this lesson.
- copy down
homeworks.
<b>Period 67 .</b>
<b>I. Teaching points : </b>By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to make and respond to
formal requests using “ mind “ and make suggestions .
- Develop Ss’ speaking skills.
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbooks , cassette , chalks , poster, lesson plan, CD,</b> a mapped
dialogue chart ..
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up : - Asks Ss go to the board to write the names of the things they have </b>
just seen from memory .
=> T corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson :</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>* Warm up : What does it say ? </b>
- Choose a student and ask him / her to go to the front of
the class with his / her back to the board so that he / she
can not see what is written on the board .
- Write the information on the board .
- Ask the rest of the class try to help the student guess
what is written on the board by asking questions until he
/ she says out right the words on the board .
Example : Yes, I do .
Ss ask : Do you like your teacher ?
Or Every day
Ss ask : How often do you have a shower ?
<b>* Pre- speaking : Introduce the topic of the speaking and </b>
some structures
1. Pre- teach structures :
- Set the scene :
Remind Ss of the exchanges between Hoa and Mr. Jones
and between Hoa and Tim in the last dialogue and elicit
the sentences from Ss .
<b>Model sentences : </b>
Whole class
Teacher – Ss
<b>***</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
1. A : Would you mind sitting in the front seat of the
taxi?
B : No problem .
2. A : Would you mind if I took a photo ?
B : Not at all .
=> Used to make and respond to formal requests
<b>Form : </b>
<b>1. Would you mind / Do you mind + verb- ing …?</b>
<b>2. Would you mind if I + Verb ( in Past simple) …? </b>
<b> Do you mind if I + Verb ( in Present simple ) ..? </b>
<b>Responses : </b>
Agreement:
No , I do not mind . / No , of course no . / Not at all . /
Please do . / Please go head .
Disagreement :
I am sorry , I can not / I am sorry , it is impossible
I,<sub>d prefer you did not . / I</sub>,<sub>d rather you did not . </sub>
- Get Ss to copy and give some more examples with
suggested words
<i>2. Cardboard Drill :</i>
1. move your car ? (v ) / 2. go out with me ? ( x)
3. wait for me ? (x) / 4. Get / coffee ? (v) / 5. Smoke ? (x)
- Call on some pairs to practice in front of class .
<b>*/ While – speaking : </b>
- Ask Ss to work in pairs
+ Open pairs : Get 3 or 4 pairs to demonstrate the
exchanges
+ Close pairs : get the whole class to practice all the
exchanges
- Give feedback
Mapped dialogue
You Tourist officer
Excuse me !
I would like to visit a
market. Would you
mind suggesting one ?
That sounds
interesting . Thank
you .
Yes ?
Not at all .
How about goping to Thai
Binh Market ?
It opens from about
5 am to pm .
You are welcome .
+ Open pairs: Ask some pairs to demonstrate the
dialogue.
+ Closed pairs : have Ss open their books and use the
between Hoa and Mr.
Jones and between
Hoa and Tim in the
last dialogue and elicit
Ss to copy and give
some more examples
with suggested words
Whole class
- Some pairs to
practice in front of
class .
Ss to work in pairs
Pair work
Teacher – Ss
Pair work
information / 101 to practice other dialogues .
Group 1 : Markets Group 2 : Museums
Group3 : Restaurants Group 4 : Stamps
Group 5 : Zoo and Botanical Garden
<b>* Post – speaking : </b>
- Call on some volunteers from each group to practice in
front of class .
- Rewrite the completed dialogues in their note books
<b>* Consolidation:</b>
-Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>* Homework : </b>
1. Do the exercises in the workbook .
2. Prepare the next lesson .
some volunteers from
each group to practice
in front of class .
-Retell the main points
of this lesson.
Individual
<b>Period 68 .</b>
<b>I. Teaching points: </b>By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to listen and match the places
in the box to their correct positions on the map . Ss will be able to use Present and Past
<b>II. Teaching aids : Text books , cassette , chalks , boards , lesson plan. </b>
posters,pictures and a chart.
<b>B/ Steps of the lesson:</b>
<b>I . Organization: </b>
- Greeting and checking attendance.
<b>II. Checking up:</b>
Two Ss go to the board to make the similar dialogue about to send a letter or parcel.
- T corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>a)</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>3.</b>
<b>b)</b>
<b>c)</b>
<b>* Warm up : Quiz what is this place ? </b>
- Ask questions and call the student who puts his / her
- Tell Ss each place consists of 3 questions ; 3 points for
the first question , 2 points for the second question , 1
point for the third question .
<i><b>a. What is this place ? </b></i>
1. it is called the city of Eternal Spring .
2. It has a lot of waterfalls and lakes .
3. You can find the most kinds of flowers here .
<i><b>b. What is this place ? </b></i>
1. It is a seaside resort .
Individual
<b>d)</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>1.</b>
2. It has a very big monument of Buddha .
3. It has an Oceanic Institute
<i><b>c. What is this place ? </b></i>
1. It is a mountainous resort .
2. It has tribal villages .
3. Sometimes it has snow .
<i><b>d. What is this place ? </b></i>
1. It is recognized as a World Heritage Site by
UNESSCO.
2. It has a lot of caves .
3. It contains of a lot of islands .
<b>*Key : </b>
a. Da Lat b. Nha Trang c. Sa Pa d. Ha Long Bay
=> Lead in the new lesson .
<b>* Pre- listening : Introduce the topic of the listening and </b>
some new words
+. Pre – teach vocabulary :
- Highway ( n)
- Tourist information center (n)
+. Set the scene “ The Jones family are going around Ha
Noi and they are talking about the directions to 5 places
in the maps . Listen to them and match the places to the
correct positions on the maps “
- Have Ss guess their correct positions on the map
- Call on some Ss to read their predictions and write
them on the board.
<b>* While – listening : </b>
- Ask Ss to list the places on the maps .
- Play the tape 2 or 3 times
- Ask Ss to compare their answers with their friends .
- Call on some Ss to read their answers and give the
correct answers
<b>Answer key : </b>
a) restaurant b) hotel c) bus station
d) pagoda e) temple
- Play the tape once more to check the answers
( pause at some important paragraph )
<b>* Post – listening : </b>
- Have Ss repeat chorally while listening to the tape .
- Correct their pronunciation
<b>* Language focus 1+2:</b>
<b>1. Language focus 1 : </b>
question .
Individual
Ss guess their correct
positions on the map
Ss to read their
predictions and write
them on the board.
Teacher – Ss
Whole class
Work in group
Individual
Pair work
Ss to open their books
and look at the picture
<b>2</b>
<b>V/</b>
<b>VI/</b>
- Ask Ss to open their books and look at the picture / 108
and set the scene “ It is time for recess and the people at
Quang Trung school are in the school yard . What are
they doing ? “
- Ask questions and call on Ss to answer then correct .
T : What is Mr Quang doing ?
Ss : He is walking / going up the stairs .
T : What is Miss Lien doing ?
Ss : She is carrying a bag .
……
Model sentences :
<b> The man walking up the stairs is Mr Quang </b>
( present participle phrase )
Form : Verb + ing -> Present participle
Use : A present participle can be used as an adjective to
qualify a noun with active meaning
- Have Ss copy
* Practice :
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to say who each person is ,
using the information above
<b>Example : The man walking up the stairs is Mr Quang </b>
- Correct and feedback
<b>2. Language focus 2 : </b>
<b>* Matching </b>
- Ask Ss to look at the words in the box and the
picture / 109 to do the matching
<b>A</b> <b>B</b> <b>Key</b>
1. box
2. truck
3. lamp
4. doll
5. flowers
6. toys
a. wrap in
1. f
2. c
3. e
4. b
5. a
6. d
- Ask Ss to look at the picture / 109 again and answer the
questions :
- Where is the old lamp made in ?
- What color is the box painted ?
- What is truck recycled from ?
- What color is the doll dressed in ?
- What are the flowers wrapped in ?
- Where are the toys kept ?
/ 108 and set the scene
“ It is time for recess
and the people at
Quang Trung school
are in the school yard .
What are they doing ?
“
Whole class
Listen and copy .
Ss to open their books
and look at the picture
/ 108 and set the scene
“ It is time for recess
and the people at
Quang Trung school
are in the school yard .
What are they doing ?
Ss to look at the words
in the box and the
picture / 109 to do the
matching
- Call on some pairs to practice asking and answering the
questions
=> Ask “ How much is the old lamp made in China ?
Model Sentences :
<b>The old lamp made in China is five dollars . </b>
( past participle phrase )
Form : Regular verb + ed Past participle
Irregular verb
Use : a past participle can be used as an adjective to
- Have Ss copy
* Practice :
- Ask Ss to look at their books , listen to the questions
and answer
* T : How much is the box painted green ?
St: The box painted green is one dollar
- Ask Ss to work in pairs , asking and answering the
questions ( Using the information in the matching )
- Call on some pairs to demonstrate for the class .
<b>* Consolidation: </b>
- Retell the main points.
<b>* Homework : </b>
1. Learn by heart new words .
2. Prepare the next lesson .
some pairs to practice
asking and answering
the questions
Ss to look at their
books , listen to the
questions and answer
Ss to work in pairs ,
asking and answering
the questions ( Using
the information in the
matching )
- Call on some pairs to
demonstrate for the
class .
Retell the main points
of this lesson.
Individual
<b>Period 69.</b>
<b>I . Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able </b>to get the information from
simple tourist advertisements .
<b>II. Teaching aids : </b>Textbooks , poster , cassette , CD, lesson plan,word square chart .
pictures , drawing .
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up :</b>
- Asks Ss to go to the board to retell the main structure grammar of last lesson.
-T corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson: </b>
Page 132 School year : 2010- 2011
<b>I/</b>
<b>*.</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>**</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>Tourist sites</b>
<b>A</b> <b>D</b> <b>D</b> <b>Y</b> <b>R</b> <b>E</b> <b>S</b> <b>O</b> <b>R</b> <b>T</b>
<b>D</b> <b>C</b> <b>A</b> <b>T</b> <b>G</b> <b>B</b> <b>E</b> <b>A</b> <b>C</b> <b>H</b>
<b>K</b> <b>N</b> <b>L</b> <b>R</b> <b>Y</b> <b>S</b> <b>A</b> <b>P</b> <b>A</b> <b>E</b>
<b>B</b> <b>U</b> <b>A</b> <b>I</b> <b>M</b> <b>K</b> <b>S</b> <b>A</b> <b>P</b> <b>C</b>
<b>A</b> <b>H</b> <b>T</b> <b>B</b> <b>V</b> <b>B</b> <b>I</b> <b>P</b> <b>J</b> <b>I</b>
<b>C</b> <b>A</b> <b>V</b> <b>E</b> <b>S</b> <b>L</b> <b>D</b> <b>K</b> <b>I</b> <b>T</b>
<b>H</b> <b>L</b> <b>N</b> <b>L</b> <b>A</b> <b>K</b> <b>E</b> <b>C</b> <b>T</b> <b>A</b>
<b>M</b> <b>O</b> <b>U</b> <b>N</b> <b>T</b> <b>A</b> <b>I</b> <b>N</b> <b>R</b> <b>D</b>
<b>A</b> <b>N</b> <b>H</b> <b>A</b> <b>T</b> <b>R</b> <b>A</b> <b>N</b> <b>G</b> <b>E</b>
<b>A</b> <b>G</b> <b>G</b> <b>E</b> <b>F</b> <b>G</b> <b>X</b> <b>C</b> <b>U</b> <b>L</b>
*Answer Key :
resort , beach , Sa Pa , caves , lakes
mountains , Nha Trang
Bach Ma , Ha Long , Da lat , Tribe
Seaside , The citadel
<b>*Pre- reading : Introduce the topic of the passage reading</b>
and some new words to students .
<b>+ Pre – teach vocabulary : </b>
- accommodation (n) : a place to live , work or stay in
- giant (adj ) = huge / very big
- slope (n)
- jungle (n) = a very thick forest
- limestone (n) = da voi
- florist (n) : a person who sells flowers
- to import >< to export
<b>+ Checking vocabulary : What and where </b>
<b>*/ While – reading : </b>
* Grid :
- Ask Ss to read the advertisements about the resorts and
check (v) the topics mentioned in the grid
- Call on some Ss to give their answers
Answer Key :
<b>+ Nha Trang : Flights to Ha Noi , railway , hotels , local </b>
transport , tourist attractions .
<b>+ Da Lat : Hotels , local transport , waterfalls , tourist </b>
attractions
<b>+ Sa Pa : Hotels , local transport , mountain slopes tourist</b>
attractions , villages .
<b>+ Ha Long Bay : World Heritage , tourist attractions , </b>
sand beaches , railways , hotels , caves , locals transport .
- Have Ss copy down
*. Matching :
- put the poster on the board and ask Ss to match the
words or phrases in Column A to column B
A B
1. Nha Trang a. tribal villages , mountain climbing
Team work
Ss to find 13 hidden
words and write them
on a piece of paper .
Individual
Teacher – Ss
Whole class
Individual
Pair work
Ss to read the
advertisements about
the resorts and check
(v) the topics
mentioned in the grid
Ss to work in pairs to
compare their answer
<b>Period70 .</b>
<b>A / The aims :.</b>
<b>I . Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to know how to write a </b>
narrative , using a guided composition .
Develop Ss’ Writing skill.
<b>II. Teaching aids : Text book , chalk , boards, posters, lesson plan,pictures. drawing,</b>
mime , picture, gap fill charts.
<b>B/ Steps of the lesson:</b>
<b>I. Organization: -Greeting and checking attendance .</b>
<b>II. Checking up:</b>
- Asks two Ss to answer the qs c-d in the book.
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>* Warm up : Which word ? </b>
( Get Ss to study the definition of a narrative by a gap
fill )
- Put the missing words on the board and have Ss study
<b>first :written – climax – attention – brief – events</b>
- Show the chart and ask Ss to ill in the gaps with the
words in the box .
- Ask Ss of each group to go to the board and write the
words as fast as possible .
- Explain the definition in Vietnamese
Answer key :
1. events 2. written 3. climax 4. attention 5. brief
1. Pre – teach Vocabulary
- canoe (n) : using picture
- to paddle (mime ) -> paddle (n)
- to hire : thue muon
- to overturn : lat up / lat do
- to rescue = to save somebody ,s life from danger
+ Get Ss to copy down .
<b>* Checking vocabulary : Slap the board </b>
<i>*. Ordering statements : Setting the scene “ Last week , </i>
<i>while on vacation in Da lat , The Jones family had quite an </i>
<i>unforgettable adventure on Xuan Huong Lake . What did they</i>
<i>do and what happened to them ? “ </i>
Group work of 4/5 Ss
Ss of each group to go
to the board and write
the words as fast as
possible .
S
Ss
<b>II./</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>3.</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
- Ask Ss to read the first part of the story / 105 and
rearrange the sentences / 106 to complete the story .
- Get some Ss to read the story aloud for the class and
correct pronunciation errors .
<b>- Give feedback : c -> a -> g ->d -> f -> b -> e</b>
<b>*While – writing : </b>
1. Explanation :
- Have Ss look at the pictures / 106 – 107 and guess the
meaning of the new words .
- Explain the meanings of these words
+ to stumble : truot chan / + to go off : vang ra
+ to realize : nhan ra
- Get Ss to copy
2. Ordering pictures :Ask Ss to look at the pictures again
and rearrange the events in the correct chronological
order to make it a story.
- Call on some Ss to give their answers and correct .
<b>- Give feedback : d -> b -> e -> h -> a -> f -> c -> g </b>
3. Write – it – up :
- Ask Ss to use the pictures already rearranged and the
given words to write the story about Uyen .
- Monitor and help Ss with words or structures while
they are writing .
* Notice : The past simple tense is often used in a
narrative .
- Ask them to exchange their writings to correct for each
other .
- Call on some Ss to read their story aloud for he class
- Give feedback :
<i> Uyen had a day to remember last week . she had a math </i>
<i>exam on Friday but she got up late . She realized her alarm </i>
<i>clock did not go off . As he was leaving home , it started to rain</i>
<i>heavily . Uyen tried to run as fast as she could . Suddenly she </i>
<i>stumbled against a rock and fell onto the road . Her school bag </i>
<i>went into a pool of water and everything got wet . Strangely , </i>
<i>the rain stopped as she got to her classroom . Luckily , Uyen </i>
<i>had enough time to finish her exam . </i>
<b>* Post – writing : </b>
- Call on some Ss to demonstrate the completed story in
front of class .
- Copy the story in their notebooks .
<b>* Consolidation: -Retell the main points of this lesson.</b>
Teacher – Ss
Whole class
Teacher – Ss
some pairs to give
their answers and
correct .
Ss to read the story
aloud for the class and
correct pronunciation
errors .
Pair work
Ss to look at the
pictures again and
rearrange the events
in the correct
chronological order to
make it a story
Teacher – Ss
Whole – class
Individual
Individual
Ss to demonstrate the
completed story in
front of class .
<b>* Homework : </b>
1. Learn by heart all new words and copy in their
notebooks .
2. Work in groups of 4 writing a story to tell the class in
the next lesson .
3. Prepare the next lesson .
Retell the main points
of this lesson.
Individual
Individual
<b>Period 71 . </b>
<b> </b>
<b>I.Teaching points : </b>By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to use Present and Past
participles to describe things and people and the requests with “ Would / Do you mind if
…..? and Would / Do you mind + V-ing …? “
Ss will be able to practice all structure grammar and do exercises of unit 11.
- Develop Ss’ four skills.
<b>II. Preparation: -Text books, lesson plan, posters .</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up: </b>
-Asks Ss to retell the new words and read again the dialogue.
- Two others to retell the main structure grammar .
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
Page 136 School year : 2010- 2011
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
- Ask Ss to look at the pictures / 109 carefully for 20
seconds and close their books .
- Tell them the team having the most right words is the
winner .
Answer Key :
box , lamp truck , flowers , elephant , bear , rabbit
<b>*Language focus</b>
+. Language focus 1 :
* Pre-teach :
- Ask Ss to open their books and look at the picture / 108
and set the scene “ It is time for recess and the people at
Quang Trung school are in the school yard . What are
they doing ? “
- Ask questions and call on Ss to answer then correct .
T : What is Mr Quang doing ?
Ss : He is walking / going up the stairs .
T : What is Miss Lien doing ?
Ss : She is carrying a bag .
T : ( Nam )
Ss : ( standing next to Miss Lien / talking to Miss Lien )
T : ( Ba )
Ss : ( sitting under the tree / reading a book )
T : ( Lan )
Ss : ( standing by the table )
T : ( Nga and Hoa )
Ss : ( playing chess )
Model sentences :
<b> The man walking up the stairs is Mr Quang </b>
( present participle phrase )
<b>Form : Verb + ing -> Present participle </b>
Use : A present participle can be used as an adjective to
qualify a noun with active meaning
- Have Ss copy
* Practice :
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to say who each person is ,
using the information above
<b>Example : The man walking up the stairs is Mr Quang </b>
- Correct and feedback
2. Language focus 2 :
<b>* Pre –teach : Matching </b>
- Ask Ss to look at the words in the box and the
picture / 109 to do the matching
<b>A</b> <b>B</b> <b>Key</b>
1. box
2. truck
3. lamp
a. wrap in
b. dress in
c. recycled from
1. f
2. c
3. e
Whole class
Team work
Ss open their books
again , go through the
words and correct .
Ss to answer then
correct
Whole class
Teacher – Ss
Choral -> individual
Ss to work in pairs to
say who each person
is , using the
information above .
Individual
Pair work
<b>A / The aims : </b>
<b>I. Teaching points : Students will be able to summarize the knowledge they have learnt </b>
form unit 9 to unit 11 so that they can supplement what they are short of . (to do the test
well ).
<b>II. Teaching aids : Test paper , chalks , boards, T gives contents of the test.</b>
<b>B/ Steps of the lesson:</b>
<b>I. Organization:</b>
<b>II. Checking up: </b>
<b>III. Contents:- Ask Ss to implement the regulations of the test lesson . </b>
- Deliver the test papers to Ss .
<b>I / Supply the correct form of the verbs : ( 2,5 ps) </b>
1. Would you mind if I ( take ) ……… a photo ?
2. Would you mind ( help ) ……… her to finish her homework ?
3. Do you mind if we ( get ) ………. a taxi to town ?
4. The cars ( make ) ……… from Japan are the best .
<b>II / Rewrite these sentences as directed : ( 2,0 ps ) </b>
1. Can I use your pen ? => Do you mind ………?
2. Could you turn off the TV ? => Would you mind ……….?
3. They built that bridge five years ago . => That bridge ……….
4. The children eat all the vegetables and meat . => All the vegetable ………
<b>III / Complete the sentences with the suitable word or phrase : ( 2,0 ps ) </b>
1. Run ( fast / fastly ) and you can catch the bus .
2. Hung promised to try ( him / his ) best in learning English .
3. I prefer walking to ( riding / ride ) a bicycle .
4. It is a ( thirty – minute / thirty – minutes ) drive from here to the city center .
<b>IV / Complete the sentences , using the given words or phrases : ( 1,5 ps ) </b>
1. Last year class 11 A / have / terrible experience.
2. One weekend / they decide / go / a picnic / Cuc Phuong National Park .
3. They / get out of / bus / lunch / because everybody / very hungry .
<b>V / Listen .You are going to listen to Lily talking about her self . You are going to listen </b>
<b>twice . Check (v) the correct box for True or False ( 2,0 Ps ) </b>
<b>Statements</b> <b>True</b> <b>False</b>
1 Lily comes from China
2 English is important to her as she will need it for her future job
3 She started learning English when she was eighteen .
4 She has a problem with listening .
5 She can understand people when they speak fast .
6 She does not find English difficult to learn .
7 She wants to be an English teacher .
8 She loves English songs , but she does not hope to become a singer .
Tapescrift :
Hi ! my name is Lily . I come from China . I am a student , a university student . I
am eighteen years old . I am studying English as a foreign language . English is important to
me because I will need it for my job in the future . I began learning English when I was very
young – at the age of eight . I think that my biggest problem is listening . People speak very
quickly , so I can not understand them . English is really hard for me to learn , but I like it . I
want to be an English teacher ; or I hope to become a singer one day because I love English
songs very much .
period 72 :
1.I open my book in ……….. to read.
a) as b)order c)so.
2.You should cool the burn………..
a)immediately b)immediate c)immediating.
3.What time ………. Lan be here.?
a)is b)shall c)will.
4. She will be here ……… three hours.
a)for b)in c)on.
5. Do you want to listen ……….. the radio.?
a)at b)to c)for.
6. Thank you very much for the commics you ………..me last week.
a)send b)sending c)sent .
2. I ( glad /am glad )that you want to know more about the subject .
3. Would you mine if I ( turn on / turned on ) the T.V ?
6. They will be ( finished / finishing ) before lunar new year.
1. Would you mind ( help ) ……… her to finish her homework ?
2. Do you mind if we ( get ) ………. a taxi to town ?
3. The cars ( make ) ……… from Japan are the best .
4. The man ( talk ) ……… to your teacher is my uncle .
=> All the vegetable ………
2.He will build a new house there.=>
A new house ………
*********** The end **********
Chữ kí giáo viên Chữ kí phụ huynh hs
………. ………..
<b>Period 73. </b>
<b>Lesson 1 : Getting started</b>
<b>Listen and read</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>* Warm up :</b>
<b>+. Guessing game ( Getting started ) </b>
- Show the pictures to Ss , one by one , and ask Ss to
guess what country it is .
- Feedback :
a) The USA b) Australia c) Thailand
d) Statue e) Canada f ) Japan
<b>+. Chatting : </b>
Individual
Ss to guess what
country it is .
<b>I.</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>*</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
T :Where do you want to visit among these countries?
Ss: ………..
T : Why ?
Ss : ………
<b>*Pre- reading : Introduce the topic of the passage reading</b>
and some new words .
+. Pre – teach Vocabulary :
- to come over : to come to Someone,<sub>s house to visit for a </sub>
short time
- to pick so up : to come and get so in your car to drive
him / her to a place
- abroad (adv ) = in a foreign country
-> to be / go / travel / live abroad
<b>* Checking Vocabulary : Rub out and remember </b>
+. True / False Prediction
- Set the scene “ Mrs Quyen is going to the USA for a
vacation . She is ringing her friend , Mrs Smith , to tell
her about the trip . “
- Put the chart on the board and ask Ss to read the
statements
a. Mrs Quyen is calling Mrs Smith from the airport in
San Francisco .
b. Mrs Smith invite Mrs Quyen and her husband to stay
with her while they are in town .
c. Mrs Quyen does not accept Mrs smith,<sub>s invitation </sub>
because she wants to stay with a Vietnamese friend of
hers .
d. Mrs Quyen and her husband will be in the USA for 3
days .
e. Mrs Quyen and her husband will come over to Mrs
Smith,<sub>s place for dinner one night .</sub>
f. Mr Thanh ; Mrs Quyen,<sub>s husband , goes abroad for a </sub>
business meeting .
- Ask Ss to work in pairs to decide if the statements are
true or false .
- Call on some Ss to read their predictions and write
them on the board .
<b>* While – reading </b>
<b>+. Checking predictions :</b>
- Have Ss open their books , listen to the tape while
reading the dialogue .
- Copy down new
lesson.
Teacher – Ss
Whole class
Teacher
- Ss to work in pairs to
decide if the
statements are true or
false .
- Some Ss to read their
predictions and write
them on the board .
Pair work
Teacher – Ss
<b>3.</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>+</b>
<b>+</b>
<b>+</b>
<b>+</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
- Call on some Ss to correct the false statements .
1. False -> Mrs Quyen is calling Mrs Smith from Ha Noi
2. True
3. False -> … because her accommodation is included in
her tickets price .
4. True
5. False -> Only Mrs Quyen will come over to Mrs Smith
,
s .
6. True
<b>+. Grid : Complete Mrs Quyen </b>,<sub>s schedule </sub>
- Ask Ss to read the dialogue again and work in pairs to
complete the grid with the information taken from the
dialogue .
- Call on some Ss to go to the board to write the
information in the grid on the board .
Date Mon 25 Tue 26 Wed 27 Thu 28
Schedule coming
to San
Francisco
Going
Having
dinner
with the
Smiths
Leaving
San
Francisco
- Have Ss copy
<b>+. Comprehension Questions </b>
- Ask Ss to look at their books and answer the questions .
- Let Ss compare their answers with their partner.
- Call on some Ss to answer
- Give feedback and correct
Answer key :
a) No , they won,t . Because they are coming on a tour ,
and their accommodation is included in the ticket price ,
so they will stay at the hotel .
b) No , he won,<sub>t . Because he will have a business </sub>
meeting in the evening that day .
c) Mrs Smith will pick her up at her hotel .
<b>*/ Post – reading : </b>
Grammar Awareness
- Tell Ss to read the dialogue again and pick out the
statements indicating the following situations
1. Making an invitation
2. Accepting an invitation
3. Declining an invitation
4. Making a complaint
- Call on Ss to give their answers and have Ss copy .
Whole class
Pair work
- Ss to read the
dialogue again and
work in pairs to
complete the grid
with the information
taken from the
dialogue .
- Some Ss to go to the
board to write the
- Ss to look at their
books and answer the
questions
- Individual
- Ss compare their
answers with their
partner
- Pair work
- Ss to read the
dialogue again and
pick out the
statements indicating
the following
situations
Whole class
Pair work
Ss to give their
answers and have Ss
1. Would you like to come and stay with us … ?
.. you must come over for dinner one night .
2. Ye , we ,<sub>d love to but we will only be in town for three </sub>
nights .
3. That is very kind of you but we are coming on a tour ..
4. Oh . dear . He is always working.
<b>* Consolidation: </b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>* Homework : </b>
1. Learn by heart new words and structures to give some
more examples .
2. Do the exercises in the workbook
3. Prepare the next lesson .
copy .
- Retell the main
points of this lesson.
- Copy down
homeworks.
- Work Individual
<b>Period 73. </b>
<b>1,Warm </b>–<b> up:</b>
- Ss match the names of the countries
in the box with appropriate
pictures/flags
-Ss discuss : Which country do you
want to visit? Why ?
<b>2.Presentation:</b>
- Preteach vocabulary
<b>*Getting started : </b>
a. The U.S.A ( The statue of Liberty)
b. Australia (The Opera House)
c. Thailand (The Pagoda and Buddha)
d. Britain (National flag)
e. Canada
f. Japan
<b>I. Vocabulary :</b>
- Checking vocab
-T sets the scene
- Student listen to the dialoge then
complete Mrs.Quyen’s
schedule(Listen and read 1 P.113)
- Students answer the questions
- Model sentences
<b>3.Practice:</b>
- Work in pairs : use given words to
make invitations ad respond
<b>4.Production:</b>
- Ss work in pairs, S1 acts as Mrs.
Quyen , to make a mini dialogue.
<b>5. CONSOLIDATION: </b>
- Retell the main points
<b>6.Homeworks:</b>
- Give tasks
Pick sb up (v) §ãn ai..
Abroad (adv) Níc ngoµi
A schedule (n) KÕ ho¹ch
<i><b>* Rub out and remember :</b></i>
* Complete mrs. Quyen’s schedule :
Schedule Mon 25 Tue 26 Wed 27 Thur 28
Coming
to San
Francisco
Going
out Havingdinner
with
the
Smiths
Leaving
San
Francisco
<b>* Listen and read 2 P.113 :</b>
a. No, they won’t because they are coming
on a tour, and their accommodation is
included in the ticket price, so they will stay
at the hotel
b. No, he won’t because he will have a
<b>* Making invitation :</b>
<i><b>Invitation:Would you like to come and stay </b></i>
with us?
<i><b>Acceptance: Yes, we’d love to/ Thank you. </b></i>
That would be very nice
<i><b>Refusal : That’s very kind of you, but we are</b></i>
coming on a tour/ Sorry, I’m afraid I’m not
free
<b>II. Practice :</b>
<b>*Word cue drill:</b>
a. Go to the movie
b. come over for dinner
c. come for my birthday party
d. have lunch with us
e. go for a walk
Example exchange :
S1: Would you like to go to the movie ?
S2:Thank you very much. That would be very nice
Role – play :
Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>Homework :</b>
-Do the exercises 1, 2 in the workbook
- Prepare well for the next period
<b>Period 74. </b>
<b>1,Warm </b>–<b> up:</b>
Cloudy, cool. cold, warm, hot, dry, fine,
humid, rainy, snowy, sunny, windy,
stormy, degree, minus, centigrade
[* Warm up : Quiz
- Tell the student who can answer the question
will get 1 or 2 good marks .
<b>1.What is the end of everything ?</b>
(letterg)
2. What word starts with T , ends with T , and
<b>is full of T ? ( Teapot ; Pot -> full of </b>
<b>3. What is the middle of New York City ? </b>
( York )
4. Which river in America has 4 eyes ?
<b>( Mississippi ) ]</b>
<b>2.Pre- stages :</b>
- Students read the flight information,
advertisement then answer the questions
to get information
- Sts guess the temperature of the 6 cities
in the table
<b>3.while- stages :</b>
- Students listen to the tape then check
their predictions
<b>* Chatting :</b>
Which country do you want to visit ?
Where will you stay ?
How do you travel ? sunny
<b>* Brainstorm :</b>
cold
Cloudy
snowy
<b>Vocabulary :</b>
Itinerary (n) lé tr×nh
Gallery (n) phịng trng bày
Flight (n) chuyến bay
Via (Pre) theo đờng
Facilities (n) c¬ së, tiƯn nghi
Brochure (n) tờ rơi
Gym (n) phòng tập thể dục
Humid (adi) Èm
Minus âm độ
Low (adj) thấp
<i><b>* Pre </b></i>–<i><b> questions</b></i>:
1. How much is a single/double room a
night ?
2. Is it near the city center ?
3. What is the departure/arrival time ?
- Students listen to the tape again then fill
in the table
- Sts use the the information to make the
dialogues
- Give feedback
<b>4.Post – stages :</b>
- Sts make a plan for their coming holiday
<b>5. CONSOLIDATION:</b>
- Retell the main points.
<b>6.Home work:</b>
- Give tasks
City Weather <sub>Low</sub>Temperature<sub>High</sub>
1. Sydney dry, windy <b>20</b> 26
2. Tokyo <b>dry, windy</b> 15 <b>22</b>
3. London <b>Humid, cold</b> <b>-3</b> <b>7</b>
4. Bangkok <b>Warm, dry</b> <b>24</b> <b>32</b>
5. NewYork <b>Windy, cloudy</b> <b>8</b> 15
6. Paris <b>cool, dry</b> 10 <b>16</b>
* Mapped dialogue :
Where shall we
stay ?
Where should we
visit?
What time should
we leave Los
Angeles ?
- The Revere Hotel is
expensive but it has a
gym
- I think we should
visit Havard Medical
School, the Museum
and Arts Gallery
- There’s a daily flight
at 10 am, would that
be OK?
<b>* Transformation:</b>
<i><b>Example :</b></i>
Depart (Hue)………
Arrive (Ho Chi Minh City)………..
Accommodation……….
Sightseeing……….
Depart (HCM City)…………..
<b>* Retell the main points of this lesson.</b>
- Do the exercises in the workbook
- Prepare well for the next period
<b>Period 75. </b>
<b>1,Warm </b>–<b> up:</b>
- Ss work in groups.
<b>2.Pre- reading :</b>
- Preteach vocabulary
- Checking vocab
- T sets the scene
- Ss pay attention to pre-questions
<b>3.while- reading :</b>
- Students read the text then complete
the grid
- Students read again and then do read 2
- Ss answer the questions from a, to e,
<b>4.Production:</b>
- Ss work in 4 groups :
+ Group 1 and 3 discuss and write down
what Mrs.Quyen did and saw on her tour
in the USA
+ Group 2 and 4 discuss and write down
the reporter’s wuestions and what he
may want to know about Mrs. Quyen’s
tour.
- Ss work in pairs, one acts as Mrs.
<b>* Braintorm :</b>
What do people do when traveling ?
(Ex: take photos, visit places of interest, eat
specialities, go swimming, go fishing, climb
mountain, go camping, go shopping, buy
souvenirs,…
<b>I. Vocabulary: </b>
- volcano (n) núi lửa
- pour out (v) phun trào
- be situated (v) đặt ở
- lava (n) nham thạch
- carve (v) Chạm, khắc
- overhead (adv) phía trên đầu
- wharf (n) cầu tàu, cầu cảng
- valley (n) Thung lũng
<b>* Slap the board :</b>
<b>* Pre-questions :</b>
1. How many places did Mrs Quyen go to
in the U.S.A ?
2. Did she enjoy her tour ?
<b>II. Practice :</b>
1. Grids and forms :
Places What she did and saw
a. Hawaii
b. NewYork
c. Chicago
d.Mount
Rushmore
Went swimming, visited
Kilawea Volcano
Went shopping, bought a
lot of souvenirs
Saw Lake Michigan
Saw the heads of 4
American Presidents
Visited Fisherman's wharf,
the Napa Valley- wine
growing area and the
Alcatraz Prison
<b>2. Comprehension questions : </b>
a. She went there by plane
b. She saw the famous prison on the island
of Alcatraz
c. It is the mount where the heads of 4
American Presidents are carved into the
rock; and it can be seen from more than
100 km away
d. It is also called "The windy city"
e. She went shopping
Quyen and the other acts as the reporter
and interview each other.
<b>5.CONSOLIDATION:</b>
- Retell the main points of thics lesson.
<b>6.Homeworks:</b>
- Give tasks
- Some Ss retell the main points of the
lesson.
- Do the exercises in the workbook
- Prepare well for the next period
<b>Period 76. </b>
-
-
<b>I . 3Points : </b>
1. b) order
2. a) immediately
3. c) will
4. a) for
5. b) to
6. c) sent
<b>II. 3 points :</b>
1. broken
2. am glad
3. turned on
4. punished
5. opening the window
6. finished
<b>III. 2 points :</b>
1. helping
2. get
3. made
4. talking
<b>IV. 2points :</b>
1. All the vegetable and meat are eaten ( by the children).
2. A new house will be built (by him ) there.
<b>Period 77. </b>
<b>1,Warm </b>–<b> up:</b>
<b>3.Practice:</b>
<b>4.Production:</b>
<b>5. CONSOLIDATION:</b>
- Some Ss to retell the main points.
- One by one
<b>6.Homeworks:</b>
<b>Period 78. </b>
<b>I.Teaching points : </b>By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to Practice in using Past
progressive with While,When and progressive tenses with “always” to complain.
Ss will be able to practice all structure grammar and do exercises of unit 12.
- Develop Ss’ four skills.
<b>II. Preparation: -Text books, lesson plan, posters .</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up: </b>
-Asks Ss to retell the new words and read again the dialogue.
- Two others to retell the main structure grammar .
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
***
I/
1.
Eg:
2.
II/
***
*
*
<b>LF2</b>
III/
***
* Warm up:
- T prepares some cards with verbs of actions.
- One of Ss from each team goes to the front ,picks
up one card and mimes. Ss of the other team guess
what the mime represents and say what s/he was
doing at 10,00 last Sunday.
<b>Model sentences</b>
<b>1. Ba was taking a shower at 8 o'clock last night</b>
<b>2. They were talking to each other at that time</b>
* Form:
<i>Use: To indicate an action that was in progress at a</i>
<i>point of time in the past</i>
<i><b>* Picture Drill:</b></i>
1. Hoa/have dinner
2. Bao/ read a comic
3. Nga/ write a letter
4. Na/ walk with her dog
5.Lan and her gradma/ talk to each other
<b>Model sentences</b>
The Le family was sleeping when the mailman came
The phone rang while Nga was eating
Form: Main clause + Adv clause
<b> * Past progressive </b>
<b> * Past simple </b>
->Key to LF2:
a - C b - F c - E
d - B e - D f - A
<b>Model sentence :</b>
Bao is always forgetting his homework
be adv V-ing…
Whole class
Team work
Teacher – Ss
- Copy down new
lesson.
- Work individually
- Look at the picture and
do exercises
- Work in pairs
- Some Ss to go to the
board to do exercises.
- Copy down new
Grammar.
- Individual
Individual
Pair work
***
<b>LF3</b>
IV/
V/
* Form:
The present progressive tense with “always”
The progressive tenses are used with always to
express a habitual action( usually bad habit as a
complaint)
** Ss do language focus 3 P.120
-> Key :
b. Mrs Nga is always losing her umbrella
c. Mr and Mrs Thanh are always missing the bus
d. Nam is always watching T.V late
f. Na is always talking on the phone
g. Liem is always going out
- Complete all the exercises in the notebook
- Prepare well for the next period.
<b>* Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>* Homeworks: </b>
- Redo all exercises
- Learn by heart vocab and model sentences of unit 12.
- Prepare for next lesson.
some pairs practice each
exchange before going
on to another exchange .
Teacher –Ss
Ss to work in pairs ,
replacing the
information with the
words in the dictation
list .
Pair work
Ss to open their books
and read the multiple
choice questions
Individual
Some Ss Retell the main
points of this lesson.
Copy down homeworks
<b>Period 79. </b>
<b>Time</b> <b> Teacher s activities</b>’ <b>Ss activitives</b>’
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>2.</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b> IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
<b>*Getting started : Chatting</b>
1.Tom likes swimming and sunbathing.
Where should he go ? Why ?
2. David is interested in ancient cities ?
3.Huckleberry likes mountain-climbing ?
4. Oliver is keen on pottery ?
5. Robinson is fond of crowed places ?
<b>*Vocabulary</b>
- fetch (v) ®i lÊy, mang vỊ
- participate (v) tham gia
- award (v) tặng thởng
- teamate (n) đồng đội
- competition (n) cuéc tranh tµi
- judge (n) Giám khảo
<i><b>* What and where.</b></i>
<b>* Listen and read : P.121</b>
<i><b>Pre- questions</b></i>
1.How many competitions in the rice-cooking
festival?
2. Do all team members go to the river to fetch
water?
Rice-cooking festival
Water fetching Fire making Rice-cooking
To fetch water To make fire To cook rice
* Matching :
The grand prize
The starting position
a piece of bamboo
The council leader
Mét mÈu tre
Vá trÊu
Gi¶i nhÊt
Chủ tịch hội đồng giám khảo
Điểm xuất phát
a. F b. F c. T d, F e. F f. T
<b>* Talk about the rice cooking festival:</b>
- Three competions
- The way to fetch the water to cook rice
- The way to make fire
- The rice cooking contest
- The way to decide the winner of the contest
<b>* Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>* Homeworks : </b>
Do the exercises 1, 2 in the workbook
Group work of 4/5 Ss
-Some groups to give
their answers and
correct
- Copy down new
lesson.
- Repeat in chorus.
T – Ss
Whole class
Team work
- Ss to go to the board
and write their words.
Individual work
T – Ss
Students listen to the
dialoge then answer
the questions
Groupwork of 4/5 Ss
T – Ss
Pair work
- Ss to write a story
using the information
from the dialogue .
Individual work
Ss guess the meaning of
the words of phrases by
matching.
Ss work in pairs or in
groups to talk about
the rice cooking
festival.
- Retell the main
points.
- Prepare well for the next period down homeworks.
<b>Period 80. </b>
***
I/
<b>* Brainstorm :</b>
decorate/ clean/ paint the house/ the room- buy
- Cook special meals/ make cakes/ get/ buy new
dress
- Write/ send postcard to friends, relatives
<b>1. vocabulary</b>
-Pomergranate (n) Quả lựu
- Peach blossoms (n) Hoa đào
- Dried waterlemon seeds (n) H¹t da
-Marigolds (n) : Cóc v¹n thä
- Sticky rice balls : bánh trôi
Spring rolls : Bánh tết , ch giũ.
<i>* Checking up: Rubout and remember</i>
* Ordering : (Speak P.123)
Whole class
Team work
Teacher – Ss
Individual
Copy down new lesson.
- Listen and repeat in
chorus.
Individual
II/
***
1.
2.
III/
***
1.
2.
IV/
V/
A F B G C H D J E J
<b>Speaking :</b>
<i><b>* Make mini dialogue</b></i>
<b>Task 1: Decide who is going to do which</b>
S1. We are having a class festival next week. I'm
going to buy asome flowers
S2: I'm going to decorate the room with……
S3:Great, I'm going to………….
S4. I'm going to……
<b>Task 2: A day before the class festival</b>
S1: Have you bought flowers
S2: Ye, I bought them yesterday. What about
decorating the room
S3: ……….
<b>Listening :</b>
<b>1. Gap fill : (Listen 1)</b>
<i><b>Answer key</b></i>
a. Mr Robinson/ flower market
b. traditional
c. dried watermelon seeds
d. make
<b>2. Complete the notes : </b>
Things to do
Mr
Robinson
Go to the flower market to buy Peach
blossoms and a bunch of marigolds
Mrs
Robinson
Go to Mrs Nga's to learn how to make
spring rolls
Liz Go to the market to buy candies and a
packet of dried watermelon seeds
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
- Learn by heart vocabulary
- Do the exercises 3, 4 in the workbook
- Prepare well for the next period
Pair work
Ss to work in pairs and
- Make a dialogue.
- Work in pairs
Some pairs practice each
exchange before going
on to another exchange .
Teacher –Ss
Ss to work in pairs ,
replacing the
information with the
words in the dictation
list
- Listen and Gap fill
Pair work
Ss to open their books
and complete the notes.
Individual
Some Ss Retell the main
points of this lesson.
Copy down homeworks
<b>Period 81. </b>
I/
II/
***
***
***
<b>** Chatting :</b>
1. When is Christmas held every year ?
(December 24th )
2. Do you celebrate Christmas ?
<b>*. Vocabulary</b>
- spread (v) (spread -spread) : Lan réng
- design (v) ThiÕt kÕ
- perform (v) performance (n) BiĨu diƠn, bi biĨu diƠn
- The patron saint (n) Th¸nh bảo hộ
- a Carol (n) bài hát giáng sinh
- Jolly (adj) = happy and cheerful (adj) vui tÝnh.
<i>* Checking up: Matching.</i>
<b>* Read : P.124-125</b>
<b>* True/ Fasle statements :</b>
1. Christmas is an important festival in every country
in the world
2. The custom of decorating a tree first appeared in
Europe
3. The leaders of the church were unhappy with
Christmas carols when they were first ferformed
4. Sending Christmas cards was an American's idea
<i><b>-> Key : </b></i>
1. F (not every but many countries in the world)
2. T 3. T
4. F (an Englishman's)
<b>* Complete the grid : (Read 2 P.126)</b>
Christmas
specials Place oforigin Date
The Christmas
tree Riga early 1500s
The Christmas
card England mid 19thcentury
Christmas
carol informationno 800 yearsago
Santa Claus USA 1823
<b>* Comprehension questions: (Read 2 P.126)</b>
<i><b>->Key :</b></i>
a. More than a century ago
b. He wanted to send Christmas greetings to his friends
c. 800 years ago
d. An American professor named Clement Clarke
Moore
e. On the description of Sain Nicholas in frofessor
Whole class
Team work
Teacher – Ss
Individual
Copy down new lesson.
- Listen and repeat in
chorus.
Individual
Pair work
Ss to work in pairs and
give their answers .
- Make a dialogue.
Ss to work in pairs ,
replacing the
information with the
words in the dictation
list
- Listen and Gap fill
Pair work
Ss to open their books
and complete the notes.
***
**
III/
IV/
Moore's poem
<b>* Reporting :</b>
Eg: On Christmas people often decorate a tree and they
send cards to relatives and friends…
<b>* Write it up :</b>
<b>* Consolidation: </b>
<b>- Retell the main points of this lesson.</b>
<b>* Homeworks : </b>
- Learn by heart vocabulary
- Let students do the exercises in the workbook
<b>- Prepare well for the next period </b>
Individual
Some Ss Retell the main
points of this lesson.
Copy down homeworks
<b>Period 82. </b>
I/
<b>* Brainstorm</b>
- fetching- water
- making- fire
- cooking- rice
- Six people take part in the rice cooking festiaval
- Fire is made in the traditional way….
<b>* Gapfill (write 1)</b>
Whole class
Team work
II/
***
III/
***
IV/
V/
1. rice-cooking 2. one/a 3. water-fetching
4. run 5. water 6. traditional 7. bamboo
8. six 9. separate 10. added
<b>* Understanding questions : (The answers to the</b>
<b>questions below can help you)</b>
1. What does this report show?
2. Where was it held ?
3. How many competitions were there ?
4. What do each team do in each contest
5. How was the festival ?
1. Name of the festival
5. How were the ativities organized ?
6. How many people took part in each activity ?
7. What did you think about the festival ?
<i><b>* Write : Write the similar report on a festival you joined</b></i>
<i>recently. </i>
<b>Eg:</b>
<i><b>This report shows how the school festival was held</b></i>
<i><b>The festival was held in the schoolyard. There were two</b></i>
<i><b>competitions: volleyball and jug of war</b></i>
<i><b>In the volleyball game, the were six students in each team</b></i>
<i><b>and each class had a volleybal team. The played against</b></i>
<i><b>each other and the 8C team had most points got the grand</b></i>
<i><b>prize.</b></i>
<i><b>There were ten students who took part in the jug of war</b></i>
<i><b>Each class had a team and the 9B team won all the others</b></i>
<i><b>got the first prize.</b></i>
<i><b>The school festival was wonderful. it made all the</b></i>
<b>Correction: </b>
<b>Consolidation: </b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>Homeworks : </b>
- Learn by heart vocabulary
- Let students do the exercises in the workbook
- Prepare well for the next period
Individual
Copy down new lesson.
- Listen and repeat in
chorus.
Individual
Pair work
Ss to work in pairs and
give their answers .
-Work in pairs
Teacher –Ss
Ss to work in pairs ,
Pair work
- Write the report on a
festival
Ss to open their books
and complete the notes.
Individual
Then compare with
their friends.
Some Ss Retell the main
points of this lesson.
Copy down
homeworks
<b>Period 83. </b>
Ss will be able to practice all structure grammar and do exercises of unit 13
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1. Eg:</b>
<b>* Warm up: </b>
<b>* Net work : Preparations for Tet</b>
<b>* Passive form:</b>
Be + Past participle
Matching:
<b>Tenses</b> <b>Form</b>
1. Present simple
2. Past simple
a. Was/were + V.pp
b. Have/has been + V.pp
Whole class
<b>2.</b>
<b>LF1:</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>LF2</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>LF3</b>
3. Future simple
4. Present perfect
c. Is/are/am + V.pp
<i><b>* Gapfill : </b></i>
<b>* LF1: P.128</b>
a. were performed b. was decorated/ put
c. is made d. will be held
e. was awarded f. was written
<b>* LF2: P.128-129</b>
- To jumble : lén xén, lµm lÉn lén
1. jumbled 2. broken 3. broken
4. scattered 5. pulled
<b>* Compound nouns :</b>
<b>A rice cooking festival</b>
<i>(article)(noun) (V-ing) (noun)</i>
- To form compound adjective: noun + V-ing
<b>* LF 3 : P.130</b>
<i><b>Answer key</b></i>
a. A fire-making contest
b. A bull-fighting festival
<i>Model sentences :</i>
He said "I'm a plumber" ->direct speech
He said he was a plumber -> reported speech
Changes:
1. Tenses:
Direct speech Indirect-reported speech
present simple
will / must / can
past simple
would / had to / could
2.Pronouns:
Depend on the Subject of the main clause
3. Advs of time:
This that / now then / here there
today that day / tomorrow the next day
b. He said he could fix the faucets
c. He said the pipes were broken
d. He said new pipes were expensive
e. He said Mrs Thu had to pay him then
Teacher – Ss
- Copy down new
lesson.
- Work individually
- Look at the books and
do exercises
- Work in pairs
- Some Ss to go to the
board to do exercises.
- Copy down new
Grammar.
- Individual
Individual
Pair work
Ss to work in pairs and
give their answers .
some pairs practice each
exchange before going
on to another exchange .
Teacher –Ss
Ss to work in pairs ,
replacing the
information with the
<b>IV/</b>
<b>LF 4</b>
<b>V/</b>
<b>VI/</b>
<b>* Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>* Homeworks: </b>
- Redo all exercises
- Learn by heart vocab and model sentences of unit 12.
words in the dictation
list .
Pair work
Ss to open their books
and do exercises.
Individual
Some Ss Retell the main
points of this lesson.
Copy down homeworks
<b>Period 84 . </b>
<b> </b>
<b>I.Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to Practice in using </b>
<b>Passive form : be + past participle and Reported speech , and revising compound</b>
<b>words and reported statements.</b>
Ss will be able to practice all structure grammar and do exercises of unit 13
- Develop Ss’ four skills.
<b>II. Preparation: -Text books, lesson plan, posters .</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up: -Asks Ss to retell the new words and read again the dialogue.</b>
- Two others to retell the main structure grammar .
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
III. New lesson:
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>1.</b>
<b>****</b>
<b>* GRAMMAR: </b>
<b>Tenses</b> <b>Form</b>
1. Present simple
a. Was/were + V.pp
b. Have/has been + V.pp
c. Is/are/am + V.pp
d. will/shall be + V.pp
<b>* Compound nouns :</b>
<i>(article)(noun) (V-ing) (noun)</i>
<b>- To form compound adjective: noun + V-ing</b>
<b>* Reported speech :</b>
<i>Model sentences :</i>
He said "I'm a plumber" ->direct speech
He said he was a plumber -> reported speech
<b>Changes:</b>
Individual
Teacher – Ss
Work with a partner
Pair work
- Ss to read the
<b>2.</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>1. Tenses:</b>
Direct speech Indirect-reported speech
present simple
will / must / can past simplewould / had to / could
<b>2.Pronouns:</b>
Depend on the Subject of the main clause
3. Advs of time:
This that / now then / here there
today that day / tomorrow the next day
Yesterday the day before / ago before
Have Ss copy
<b>Read the following passage and choose the item (a, </b>
Hi! I’m Dean. I’m from England. My favorite time
of the year is Christmas, which is on 25 December.
That’s when Christians celebrate the birth of Christ. In
the middle of December we send a lot of cards to our
friends and family, here and abroad. Then we get a big
<i><b>tree and decorate it with lights and other things. On</b></i>
Christma Day, we give each other presents. We have
one enormous meal with turkey, and after that, we
have Christmas pudding.
<b>1. When is Christmas held?</b>
a. On 25 December / b. In the middle of December
c. In the middle of the year / d. no information
<b>2.Christmas is held because Christians want to__.</b>
a. have a good time/ b. celebrate the birth of Christ
c. visit their friends and family / d. decorate big trees
<i><b>3. What does the word ‘decorate’ in line 5 mean?</b></i>
a. make something look nicer/ b. paint something
c. make something look worse / d. buy something
<b>4. On Christmas Day, people_____ .</b>
a. give each other presents / b. have an enormous
meal with turkey / c. have Christmas pudding
d. all are correct
<b>5. Which of the following is not true?</b>
a. Dean is English.
b. At Christmas, people get big trees and decorate it.
c. Dean prefers Halloween to Christmas.
d. In the middle of December, people send a lot of
Christmas cards to their friends and family.
*Work with a partner
- Ask Ss to copy the vocabulary
- Ask ss to work in pairs to complete the letter using the
words in the box
- Get some Ss to give their answers
- Give feedback and correct.
- Call on some Ss to read the complete letter aloud .
<b>* Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>* Homework : </b>
1. Rewrite the letter beginning with : “ Nam,<sub>s grandparents</sub>
are delighted that he passed his English exam ……”
2. Do the exercises in the workbook .
according to
theinstructions
- Ss to rewrite the
sentences in the passive
form
Pair work
Teacher – Ss
Individual
Whole class
Pair work
Teacher – Ss
Whole class
Ss to read the letter and
match the words
Individual
Ss to give their answers
Read the letter aloud
Listen and copy
ss to work in pairs to
complete the letter using
the words in the box
work in pairs.
- Retell the main points
of this lesson.
- Copy down
homeworks.
<b>Period 85. </b>
<b>Time</b> <b> Teacher s activities</b>’ <b>Ss activitives</b>’
<b>***</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1.</b>
*Getting started : Matching
a. The Pyramid
b. Sydney Opera House
c. Stonehenge
<b>*. Vocabulary</b>
- Clue (n) Manh mèi
- Rule (n) luËt ch¬i
<b>* Presentation dialogue : </b>
(Listen and read – P.131-132)
<b>* Gapfill : (Listen and read 2 P.132)</b>
1. game 2. place 3. clue 4. Vietnam
5. American 6. Gold 7. right 8. was
" Nga , Nhi and Hoa are playing a language game
called guessing game. How does this game work?
Rearrange the statements in the right order of the
game"
- Puts the statements chart on the board.
- Asks sts to read the statements and put them in the
right order.
- Calls on some pairs to go to the board and write
their answers
<b>( - wonder (n): kú quan</b>
<b> - gold gate bridge: cầu cổng vàng</b>
<b> - clue (n): gỵi ý )</b>
Sts to open their books and read the dialogue on
page 131, 132 while listening to the tape
<b>* Ordering sentences :</b>
<i><b>How to play the guessing game?</b></i>
1. B asks questions to find out what it is
Group work of 4/5 Ss
-Some groups to give
their answers and
correct
- Copy down new
lesson.
- Repeat in chorus.
- Asks sts to open their
books and read the
dialogue on page 131,
132 while listening to
the tape
- Plays the tape.
- Checks if sts' guesses
are right or not
- Have sts to copy
statements in the right
order
<b>2.</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b> IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
2. A thinks of a famous person or place
3. B wins if he/she can guess the correct answer
4. A gives B a clue
5. B loses if he/she can't guess the correct answer
6. A only can answer "yes" or "no"
<i><b>->Key: 2 - 4 - 1 - 6 - 3- 5</b></i>
<b>*Grammar :</b>
<i><b>Model sentences:</b></i>
I don't know how to play it
<b>* Form: </b>
how to play it
Please tell me where I can go during the visit
where to go
A B
Eg: I don't know how I can play it
to play it
b. Nga showed Nhi where to get tickets
c. Nga pointed out where to buy sourvenirs
d.Nga advised Nhi how to go from My Son to H.An
e. Nga told Nhi what to do there during the visit
<b>* Guessing game :</b>
Teacher: It is a wonder and it is in Asia
St:(guess)
Teacher : yes/ no
<b>* Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main points ị thí leson.
<b>* Homeworks:</b>
- Do the exercises 1, 2 in the workbook
- Prepare well for the next period
Students listen to the
dialoge then answer
the questions
Groupwork of 4/5 Ss
T – Ss
Pair work
- Ss to write a story
using the information
from the dialogue .
Individual work
Ss guess the meaning of
the words of phrases by
matching.
- Asking sts to read the
summary again
- Write the words on the
board
- Asks sts to match the
- Asks some sts to give
their answers
- Retell the main points.
- Listen and copy down
homeworks.
<b>Period 86. </b>
- Further practice in seeking information about famous places or people using “Yes / No”
questions both in “direct speech” and “indirect speech”
III. New lesson :
***
I/
<b>Warm- up: Who is the fastest?</b>
- Informs the topic and time limit.
- Delivers posters to sts
- Tells sts to put their posters on the board
- Gives feedback and corrects
*Write 10/15 famous world places within 3 minutes.
<b>* Speak:</b>
1. It was designed and built by the French civil
2. It is in Sound Central Asia, 8,848 meters high
above sea level.
3. It was built from 246- 208 BC and some people
say it can be seen from the moon.
4. It is a bell striking the hours in the clock tower of
the houses of Parliament in London.
Answer key:
1. Eiffel Tower. / 2. Mount Everest
3. Great wall of china . / 4. Big Ben
5. Empire State building USA (toà nhà thơng mại
Mỹ)
6. Phong Nha cave (động Phong Nha)
<i>Suggest:</i>
1. Have they just built the Eiffel Tower in Paris?
2. Is the Empire State Building located in New York
city?
3. Are the Petronas Twin Towers located in
Malaysia?
4. Is the Great Barrier Reef in Australia?
5. Have you ever seen Mount Rushmore?
6. Is Mount Everest in Nepal?...
<b>Modal sentences:</b>
Whole class
Team work
Teacher – Ss
Individual
Copy down new
lesson.
- Listen and repeat in
chorus.
Individual
Pair work
Ss to work in pairs and
give their answers .
Sts to write yes/no
questions about 10
places in the box,
using the information
in the matching.( each
st in a group asks a
question)
II/
***
1.
\
2.
III/
***
I said to Lan, "Is Hue citadel in the central
Vietnam?"
(Yes/ no questions direct speech)
<b>* Sets the scene:</b>
+ Ask a st: (Lan)
<i>T: Is Hue citadel in the central Vietnam?</i>
- Asks sts to listen:
T: I asked Lan if Hue citadel was in the central
Vietnam. She said that it was
I asked Lan If
whether Hue citadel was in the Central Vietnam
( Main clause) Indirect (yes/ no )
question
<b>Concept check:</b>
Indirect: Yes/ No question
<b>Form: V + O + if / whether + S + V</b>
Use: - to say to ask / want to know
- If the verb in the main clause is in past tense, the
tense in the indirect questions must be changed:
Direct question Indirect question
Present simple past simple
Past simple past perfect
Present perfect Past perfect
Yes no
- Is Phong Nha cave in
Southern Viet Nam?
- Is Petronas Twin Towers the
tallest building in the world?
- Is the great Barrier Reef a
world Heritage Site?
- Is the Empire State Building
in Australia?
- Is Ha Long bay a world
Heritage Site?
- Is Big Ben in Paris French?
Ex: I asked Hoa if Phong Nha cave in Southern Viet
Nam. She said that it wasn’t…….
<b>* Language focus 2:</b>
Sets the scene:
“Yesterday Nga and Nhi talked about My Son, one
of the world culture Heritage of Vietnam. Beside
answering some of Nhi's question, Nga gave her
<i>some additional information about My Son .</i>”
<i>- Asks sts to report what Nhi asked Nga, using </i>
<i>reported speech.</i>
<i>- Calls on some sts to resay the use of the Indirect </i>
<i>Yes/ No question if necessary</i>
<i>- Shows the questions on the board</i>
- Models the first question and asks sts to listen.
a. Do you know My Son, Nga?
Nhi asked Nga if / whether she knew My Son
Sts ask and answer the
questions, checks yes
or no
-A group to
demonstrate their work
<b>S: Yes, it is</b>
- Write the statement
on the board.
- Have sts to copy
Individual
Some Ss Retell the
main points of this
lesson.
Copy down
homeworks
- Chooses a group's
answer to demonstrate
the model (asking and
reporting)
- Some pairs in each
group to demonstrate
the exchanges and the
tell one of them to
report.
- Have sts work in
their groups
- Calls on sts in
different groups to
report in front of the
class
- Gives feedback and
corrects
Sets the scene:
- Calls on some sts to
resay the use of the
Indirect Yes/ No
question if necessary
- Shows the questions
on the board
- Models the first
question and asks sts
to listen.
IV/
V/
b. Nhi asked Nga if / whether it was far from Ha
Noi.
c. Nhi asked Nga if / whether My Son was Quang
Nam province
d. Nhi asked Nga if / whether Many people lived at
My Son
e. Nhi asked Nga if / whether Many tourists visited
My Son every year
f. Nhi asked Nga if / whether She wanted to visit My
Son one day
<b>Consolidation:</b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
<b>Homeworks: </b>
- Learn by heart vocabulary
- Do the exercises 3, 4 in the workbook
- Prepare well for the next period
- Student to read the
question, another
student read the
reported speech
sentence
- Retell the main
points.
- Listen and copy
down homeworks
<b>Period 87. </b>
Listening for details by deliberating the mistakes.
- Develop Ss’ listening
<b>II. Teaching aids : </b>
Textbooks , cassette , chalks , poster, lesson plan, CD.
<b>I. Organization: </b>
<b>- Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up :</b>
- Asks 2Ss to go to the board to read the dialogue of unit 14.
=> T corrects and give them marks.
III. New lesson :
<b>***</b>
<b>Crossword puzzle</b>
- Puts the chart on the board
- Asks sts to draw the crossword in their
notebooks
- Asks sts to listen and fill in the
crossword
- Collects sts's answers and gives them
1.
Unable to find sth / Sb
2. Something that help you find out
L O S E
C L U E
J U N G L E
<b>I/</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
good points if they are right
<i><b>*Pre-teach vocabulary</b></i>
- Elicits words from sts
<i>- relaxing (a): gi¶i trÝ</i>
<i>- crystal clear (a): trong suèt (nh pha lª)/- coral</i>
<i>(n): san hô</i>
<i>- to snorkel (v): bơi lặn có ống thở</i>
- Have sts copy the vocabulary
<i><b>Checking technique: What and where</b></i>
- Elicits words from sts again and write
them inside circles
- Gets sts to repeat and rubs out the words
not the circle.
- Continues until the circles are empty
- Gets sts to repeat the rubbed out words
by pointing at the empty circles
- When sts seem to remember all the
words, ask sts (5 at a time) to come to the
board to fill in the circles again.
<i><b>*. Listen:* Sets the scene:</b></i>
" You are going to listen to an
advertisement on the tape. There are 4
mistakes in the advertisement in your
books. What are they?"
- Have sts read the advertisement in their
books for a few minutes.
- Asks sts some questions about the
geographical names in the paragraph.
- Plas the tape 2 or 3 times.
- Gets some sts to give their answers
- Plays the tape the last time, gives
feedback and correct.
<i><b>* Pre-teach:</b></i>
- Elicits the target language from sts
- Get sts to copy.
- Asks sts open their books and complete
the passage on 137 with the right form of
the verbs.
- Calls on some sts to give their answers
- Corrects and have a st read the whole
paragraph aloud.
an answer to a question
3. A very thick forest
1. to make a suggestion
<b>* Listen</b>
<i>- relaxing (a): gi¶i trÝ</i>
<i>- crystal clear (a): trong suèt (nh pha </i>
<i>lª)/-coral (n): san hô</i>
<i>- to snorkel (v): bơi lặn có ống thở</i>
<i><b>*Answer key:</b></i>
<b>" Look no further than beautiful far </b>
<b>north Queens land. Stay right on </b>
the beach at the Coconut Palm
<b>Hotel. Take guided tours through </b>
<b>the rainforest, swim in the </b>
crystal-clear water of the coral Sea and
Snorkel amongst the coral of the
<b>Call (077) 6924 3927 for more </b>
information
<b>* Language focus 4:</b>
1. I want to go out at weekends
to infinitive
2. She enjoins swimming very much
verb-ing
3. He can speak many language
modal verb bare infinitive
Concept Check:
1. Form:
<b>S + Verb + to infinitive verb</b>
<i> * Use: Most of the verbs in English</i>
<i>are followed by a to infinitive</i>
<b>2. Form: S + verb + verb ing</b>
<i>*Use: Same use as enjoy: start, </i>
<i>begin, advise...</i>
3. Form:
<b>S + modal verb + bare infinitive</b>
<b>*</b>Use: Modals: can, could, will,
would, shall, should, may,
<b>Answer key: </b>
1. to jog/ 2. go
3. to gather (tap trung)
4. to rain / 5. to reach
6. to continue
7. get
- Asks sts to write 6 sentences of their
own, using three forms above.
- Monitors and assists sts if necessary
- Calls on some sts to go to the board and
write their sentences.
- Give feedback and correct
- Award good marks to sts having good
and right sentences
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
- Learn by heart vocabulary
- Do the exercises 3, 4 in the workbook
- Prepare well for the next period
- Retell the main points.
- Listen and copy down homeworks
<b>Period 88. </b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>***</b>
- Draws dashes on the board, each dash is
for a letter of the world
- Have sts guess the letters, one by one.
- For every wrong guess, draw a line
(from 1 to 8) Sts will lose the game if
they guess wrong 8 times.
<b>*Revision: Coral, crystal-clear, </b>
<b>snorkel, relaxing</b>
<i><b>*. Pre-teach vocabulary:</b></i>
- Elicits words from sts
- have sts to copy
*Checking technique: Slap the board
<b>Compile, claim, god, royal, honor, </b>
<b>religious</b>
<b>* Read:</b>
<i>- ancient Greece: Hy lạp cổ đại</i>
<i>- compile (v): biên soạn</i>
<i>- claim (v): khẳng định, tuyên bố</i>
<i>- royal (a): hồng tộc</i>
<i>- Buddhist religious center: trung </i>
<i>t©m tÝn ngìng PhËt gi¸o.</i>
<b>III/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
<b>VI/</b>
<i><b>*. True / False prediction:</b></i>
- Put the chart on the board
- Asks sts to decide if the statements are
true or false
- Writes sts' guesses on the board
- Asks sts to read the text on page 134, to
check their guesses.
- Calls on some sts to correct the false
statements.
<i><b>*. Multiple choice: (prepare it as a </b></i>
listening task)
- Asks sts to choose the best answers to
- Puts the answer chart on the board
- Read statements aloud and make hand
gestures to show the missing words
- Asks sts to choose A, B, C or D
- Correct and have sts write the right
answers in their notebooks
<i><b>*. Grid</b></i>
- Draws the grid on the board and have
sts to copy it
- Asks sts to read the text again and fill in
the grid with the information taken from
the text or the fact.
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
- Calls on some sts to give their answers
- Do the exercises in the workbook,
page...
wonders of the world.
2. The only surviving wonder is the
Pyramid of Cheeps in Egypt.
3. Today, we can still see the
hanging Gardens of Babylon in
present-day Iraq
4. Angkor Watt was originally built
to honor a Hindu God
5. The Great wall of China first
wasn't in the list of the seven
wonders of the world
6. In the early 15th century, the
Khoneo King chose Angkor Watt as
the new capital
<i><b>*Answer key:</b></i>
1. False: A Greek man named
Antipater did it / 2. True
3. False: Three only surviving
wonder is the pyramid of Cheeps in
Egypt
4. True. / 5. True
6. False: In the early 15th century,
the Khmer King chose Phnom Penh
as the new capital
<i><b>*Answer key:</b></i>
a. The only surviving wonder on
<b>Antipater's list is the Pyramid of </b>
<b>Cheops</b>
b. Angkor watt was originally built
<b>for Hindus</b>
<b>c. Angkor watt was part of a royal </b>
<b>Khmer city a long time ago</b>
<b>d. In the 1400s, The Khmer King </b>
<b>chose Phnom Penh as the new </b>
<b>capital</b>
Wonders of the world Country
1. Hanging gardens of
Babylon
2. The statue of Zeus
3. Pyramid of Cheops
5. The Taj Mahal
6. The Gold Gate
Bridge
7. Angkor Wat
Iraq
Greece
Egypt
China
India
USA
Cambodia
<b>Period 89. </b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>Guessing game:</b>
<b>Wonders of the world</b>
- Asks sts to think of one of the wonders
of the world and write it on a piece of
paper.
- Calls on a student to the front of the
class with his her paper
- Have the rest of the class ask him/ her
yes-no questions to guess the wonder
- The sts having the right guess will take
the place of the last sts
<i><b>+. Pre-teach vocabulary</b></i>
- Elicits words from sts
- Gets sts to copy.
Checking technique: Rub out and
remember
<i><b>*. Insertion:</b></i>
- Asks sts to read the letter Tim sent to
Hoa about his trip to the grand Canyon
on page 135
- Tells sts to complete the letter by
- Calls on some sts to read their
completed letters in front of the class.
- Gives feedback and corrects
<i><b>+. Writing</b></i>
- Sets the scene:
- Draw the outline on the board and
elicits some details.
- Have sts to talk about something they
have done first by asking questions for
them to answer.
<b>* Write</b>
<b>Vocabulary</b>
- ranger (n) Ngời bảo vệ rừng, quản
lí công viên
- edge (n) Cạnh , mÐp
- canyon (n) hỴm nói
- breathtaking (adj) hÊp dÉn, ngo¹n
mơc
- temperate (adj) ơn đới
- stone age (n) Thời kì đồ đá.
<i><b>Answer key:</b></i>
1. C
2. B
3. D
4. A
<b>Outline</b>
+ place (phong nha cave / Cuc
Phuong national park...)
+ Distance (100 km / 12 hours by
train...)
+ How to get there (by bus /
plane...)
+ Sights (beautiful/ breathtaking....)
+ weather (temperate/ sunny /
cold...)
+ How you feel (happy/ relaxed...)
<b>E.g :</b>
<b>(date, month)</b>
<b>Dear……, </b>
<b>How are you ? I hope you and</b>
<b>your family still has a good health</b>
<b>and you will have a good result</b>
<b>for your exam.</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
<b>VI/</b>
- Asks stst to write the letter in their
notebooks.
- Monitors and assists sts if necessary
- Calls on some sts to read their letters in
front of the class.
- Gives feedback and corrects
<i><b>+. Interview:</b></i>
- Asks sts tto use the outline on the board
and the information in their letters to
- Model: Calls on a student to stand up to
answer the questions
- Asks sts to play in turn the role of an
interviewer and an interviewee
- Monitors and corrects.
- Calls on some pairs to demonstrate their
interview
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
- Write the completed letter(1) in your
notebooks.
- Do the exercises in the workbooks
page...
<b>trip to Ha Long Bay. It is a world</b>
<b>heritage site. We spent 5 days</b>
<b>there and I didn t want to leave.</b>’
<b>There are many beautiful</b>
<b>limestone islands and magnificent</b>
<b>That s all I have time to tell you</b>’
<b>about. What do you plan to do</b>
<b>during the summer vaccation ?</b>
<b>Write to me.</b>
<b>Your friend,</b>
<b>(Signature)</b>
* Model:
+ Where have you just visited?
+ How far is it?
+ How did you get there?
+ What is it like ?/ Is it beautiful?
+ How about the weather?
+ How did you feel?
- Let students do the exercises in
the workbook
- Prepare well for the next lesson.
<b>Period 90 . </b>
<b> </b>
<b>I.Teaching points : By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to Further practice in seeking </b>
information about famous places or people using “Yes / No” questions both in “direct
speech” and “indirect speech”. Students will be able to use the past simple passive and
reported speech with the “yes/no questions”.
- Develop Ss’ four skills.
<b>II. Preparation: -Text books, lesson plan, posters .</b>
<b>B/ Steps of the lesson:</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up: -Asks Ss to retell the new words and read again the dialogue.</b>
- Two others to retell the main structure grammar .
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>*Warm- up:Bingo</b>
<b>*. Presentation:</b>
- Do the exercises on the work book on
<i><b>*Suggested words:</b></i>
temperate, breathtaking, royal,
religious, canyon, pyramid, edge, god,
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>IV/</b>
page…... Revision:
- Asks sts to resay the form of the passive in
the past simple tense
Has sts to look at the exercise and choose the
right verbs in the box for the gap in the
sentences.
<i><b>*. Practice:</b><b> Asks sts to complete the </b></i>
sentences with the right passive form of the
verbs
- Calls on some sts to give their answers
- Gives feedback and corrects.
<i>* Production : Writes the words and their </i>
meaning on the board.
- Asks sts to read the exercises again and do
the matching
- Calls on some sts to go to the board o draw
the lines to connect the words
<b>* Presentation</b><i><b> : * Sets the scene:</b></i>
<i>“Yesterday Nga and Nhi talked about My Son, </i>
<i>one of the world culture Heritage of Vietnam. </i>
<i>Beside answering some of Nhi's question, Nga </i>
<i>gave her some additional information about My </i>
<i>Son”.</i>
Asks sts to report what Nhi asked Nga, using
reported speech.
- Calls on some sts to resay the use of the
Indirect Yes/ No question if necessary
- Shows the questions on the board
- Models the first question and asks sts to
listen.
<b> Practice: Substitution Drill:+ Oral drill:</b>
- Calls on one student to read the question,
another student read the reported speech
sentence
- Gives feedback and correct if necessary
- Go on asking sts to do the rest questions
jungle, compile (10 words)
<b>* Past form:</b>
<b>was / were + past participle</b>
Ex: A shirt was bought yesterday
<i><b>Answer key:</b></i>
a. was completed.
b. was constructed
c. was designed
d. was presented
e. was designed
* Matching:
<i>1. construct A. thiÕt kÕ</i>
<i>2. design B. đoàn thám hiểm</i>
<i>3. summit C. xây dựng</i>
<i>4. expedition D. hớng dẫn viên</i>
<i><b>Answer key:</b></i>
1. C 2. A 3. E 4. B 5. D
<b>* Indirect questions with IF and </b>
<b>Wether(Reported speech with yes/no </b>
<b>questions)</b>
<i><b>Model sentences</b></i>
I said to Lan"Is the Great Wall in
England ?"
I asked Lan if/whether the Great
Wall is in England
<b>Form: </b>
<b>S + asked + (O) if/whether S + V</b>
<i><b>* Notice the changes:</b></i>
say asked
question statement
Simple present simple past
Eg: I asked Tung if/whether
Stonehenge was in England. He said it
<b>* E</b> xercises:
a. Do you know My Son, Nga?
Nhi asked Nga if / whether she
knew My Son
<b>V/</b>
***
***
orally with the same steps
<b> Production:</b>
+ Writing drill
- Calls on some sts to go to the board and
write reported sentences
- Corrects and asks sts to write the right
answers in their notebooks.
<b>* Practice: Word cue drill:</b>
+ Oral drill:
- Shows the word cue chart on the board
- Models the first question and asks sts to
- Checks if sts recognize the model sentence
( S + V+ question word + to infinitive)
- Asks one student to say the next sentence
- Gives feedback and corrects
- Has sts do the rest of the exercise orally
with the same steps
+ Writing drill:
- Asks some sts to go to the board and write
completed sentences
- Gives feedback, corrects and has sts to copy
*Production:
- Delivers posters to sts
- Writes the question words on the board and
asks sts to write completed sentences of their
own.
- Tells sts to write their sentences on posters
and puts them on the board after finishing
them
- Award sts good marks if their sentences are
<b>* Consolidation: </b>
- Retell the main points of this lesson.
b. Nhi asked Nga if / whether it was
far from Ha Noi.
c. Nhi asked Nga if / whether My Son
was Quang Nam province
d. Nhi asked Nga if / whether Many
people lived at My Son
e. Nhi asked Nga if / whether Many
tourists visited My Son every year
f. Nhi asked Nga if / whether She
wanted to visit My Son one day
a. tell / how / go there
Nga told Nhi how to go there
a. Nga told Nhi how to go there
b. Nga showed Nhi where to get
tickets
c. Nga pointed out where to buy
souvenirs
d. Nga advised Nhi how to go from
My Son to Hoi An
e. Nga told Nhi what to do there
during the visit
<b>*Question words before To_ </b>
<b>infinitive or Bare _ infinitive:</b>
* To_ infinitive : Là Đt nguyên thể có
To.
- Di sau : Want, decide, start, Try,
begin,stop…
* Bare_ infinitive: Đt Nguyên thể ko có
To.
- Đi sau các đt khuyết thiếu: can,
could, may , might, would,
should,will, shall …
Answer key:
1. to jog /
2. go
3. to gather
4. to rain
5. to reach
6. to continue
<b>VI/</b>
VII/
<b>*. Homework:</b>
-Prepare for the test
Turn the passive sentences into the active in
language focus 1
Copy down homeworks.
§ 91:
<i><b>Name:</b><b>………</b><b>.</b></i>
<i><b>Class :</b><b>………</b><b>..</b></i>
<b>I.choose the best answer: ( 3p).</b>
1.The girl ………..when she ………. .
a) fell / was running b) fall /running c)fall /run.
2. Are you free ………Tuesday evening ?
a)at b)in c)on
3.She is not very beautiful ………. She is intelligent.
a)asked b)is always asking c)always asking.
5.She didn’t know ……… to choose,the red book or blue book.
a)what b)how c)which.
6.While I ……….. at things , my mother ……….with my bags.
a)was looking /was helping b)looking / helping c)looked / help.
<b>II.Put the corrects forms of the verbs in bracket : (3p).</b>
1.Nga said thatshe would leave the ……….day.(follow )
2.The Sydney Opera House was ………in 1973. ( complete).
3. I ……….with my friend at 10pm last night. (sleep).
4. What ……….. you ……….at 8am last Monday ? (do).
5.The children ………when it started to rain. ( play ).
6. Ba ……….his homeworks while his brother ………. a commic.(do/read).
<b>III.Change the following sentences : (2p).</b>
1.She ask her mother if she was alright .
=> ………..
2.She said to me : “Are you a journalist (nhà báo) ?”.
=> ………..
<b>IV.Complete these sentences with the suitable words or phrases in the </b>
<b>brackets(2p)</b>
1. I’m very (bored / boring). Let’s go somewhere.
2. They don’t know ( nothing / anything) about the Golden Gate Bridge
3. She (is always borrowing / always borrowed) from me and she (never remembers /
has never remembered) to pay me back.
4. The policeman explained to us ( how / how can we/ how we can) to get to the airport.
<i> Chữ kí giáo viên chữ kí phụ huynh</i>
<i>……… </i>
<i>.</i>
<i>………</i>
<b>Period 92. </b>
<b>Time</b> <b> SS' and teacher's activities</b> <b>contents</b>
<b>***</b> <b><sub>Warm- up:*Brainstorm</sub></b>
- Writes the topic on the board.
- Asks sts to think of the topic and
express their opinions
<b> Computer can help us: </b>
- Save time
- Learn interestingly
- learn more quickly
<b>I/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b> IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
- Collects sts’ opinions and write
them on the board
<b> Pre- reading:</b>
*Pre-teach vocabulary:
- Elicits words from sts
- Have sts to copy
<b>Checking: slap the board</b>
* True / false prediction:
- Sets the scene:
“ Nam and his father, Mr. Nhat are
talking about the problem of the
computer they’ve just bought. What
happens to the computer?”
- Calls on some pairs to give their
answers.
- Writes the sts’ guesses on the
board.
<b>* While- reading:</b>
- Asks sts to open their books read
the dialogue on page 138 and listen
to the tape
- Gives feedback and corrects.
* Reading comprehension:
- Explains the word: fact and opinion
+ Fact: a thing that is known to be
true, especially when it can be
proved
<i>+ Opinion: your feelings or thoughts </i>
<i>about someone or something, rather </i>
<i>than a fact</i>
- Gets sts to read the statements and
check ( ) the suitable boxes
- Calls on some sts to give their
answers
- Have sts to copy
<b>*Post- reading: </b>
* Write it up:
- Asks sts to use reported speech to
rewrite the dialogue
- Divides the class into 2 groups and
assign each group to report about 3
- computer are convenient / easy for
keeping / storing information
- Computers are very quick in giving
answers to our questions
<b>* Listen and read: </b>
* check:
<b>Answer key: </b>
1. True
2. True
3. False ( Nam knows how to connect a
printer and he has connected it properly)
4. False ( Mr. Nhat thinks it isn’t very
helpful)
5. True
6. False (Mr. Nhat thinks the company
should do something with it)
* Answer keys:
<b>Fact opinion</b>
a. The printer isn’t…
b. There shouldn’t be
c. I know how to …
d. The manual isn’t..
e. I bought it…
f. I don’t know ….
<b> * Language focus 1: Present perfect with </b>
<b>Yet and already </b>
<b>- Yet : used in questions and negative </b>
statements
<b>- Already : used in positive statements </b>
<b>+ Yet : at the end of the sentence . </b>
<b>+ Already : between auxiliary have and </b>
past participle
EX:
T : Has Ba done his homework yet ?
T : Has Ba tidied the room yet ?
to 4 sentences
- Have them to write their report on
a poster and puts it on the board for
public check.
<b>* Consolidation: </b>
- Retell the main points of this
lesson.
<b>*. Homework: </b>
- Do the exercises on the work book
on page…..
<b>Period 93. </b>
<b>I. Teaching points : By the end of the lesson, students will be able to use some common </b>
useful expressions to express agreement and a disagreement. (Ss will be able to Expressing
and responding to opinions about things.)
- Develop Ss’ speaking skill.
<b>II. Teaching aids : </b>
Textbooks , cassette , chalks , poster, lesson plan, CD.
<b>B/ Steps of the lesson:</b>
<b>I. Organization: </b>
<b>- Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up :</b>
- Asks 2Ss to go to the board to read the dialogue of unit 13.
=> T corrects and give them marks.
III. New lesson :
<b>I/</b>
<b>I. Warm- up:</b>
<i><b>Guessing game: “ Do you think that….?”</b></i>
- Asks sts each to think of one of the ways
computers are helpful and write it on a piece of
paper.
- Calls on a student to the front of the class
- Tells sts the one to have the right guess will get
one good mark and go on answering the
classmates’ questions.
<i><b>*Presentation: * Brainstorm:</b></i>
- Writes the topic on the board:
“ Do you think that computer
are……..?
* Speak:
Opinion I like…
I don’t like
I think…
I feel….
I don’t believe…
Agreemen
t
So do I
I agree
you are right
<b>II/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>***</b>
<b> “useful expressions to express agreement and</b>
<b>a disagreement”</b>
- Puts the table on the board and elicits sts’
answers then write them in the table
- Explains the phrase “on the other hand” .
- Gets sts to copy
* Matching:
- Puts the photocopied pictures (p. 139) on the
right of the board and word cues on the left (not
in order)
- Asks sts to match the words with the pictures
- Calls on some sts to go to the board to draw
the matching lines
<b>*Practice:</b>
- Erases the words but leave the pictures
- Asks sts to use the adjectives in the box on
page 140 you express their opinions after going
through the meaning of some new words (work
in pairs)
- Asks sts to use the pictures on the board to
practice speaking with their partners
- Calls on some pairs to demonstrate for the
class.
- Gives feedback and corrects
<b>a. Driving a car or Learning to drive a car:</b>
<i><b>S1: Driving a car is very easy.</b></i>
<i><b> Or: Learning to drive a car can be challenging </b></i>
<i><b>b. Reading comic books:</b></i>
<i> - Coming books are boring. I don’t like them</i>
- Reading comic books is interesting
<i><b>c. Playing in the rain:</b></i>
- Walking in the rain is very fun
- Rain makes the flowers grow
<i><b>d. Foreign food: hamburgers, pizza, French fries</b></i>
This kind of food can be unhealthy
<b>*Production: </b>
<i><b>+ Mapped dialogue:</b></i>
- Presents the dialogue and has sts to repeat
sentence by sentence
- Calls on one sts to demonstrate the dialogue
agreemen
t
Yes, but on the other
hand….
Disagree
ment
I disagree
I can’t agree with you
No, I think……..
1. Reading comic books d.
2. Playing in the rain a.
3. Driving a car b.
1. b 2. c 3. a 4. d
<i><b>Oral drill: </b></i>
T: I think driving a car is very easy
S: I disagree. I think it is difficult to
drive a car or So do I.
<i>- entertaining: gi¶i trÝ, </i>
- time-consuming(n): tèn nhiỊu th× giê
<i>Suggestions: </i>
<i><b>a. I disagree I think it is very easy </b></i>
<i><b>once you get used to it or you are </b></i>
right, it is difficult to get used to
driving in traffic.
<i><b>b.</b></i>
- Neither do I. I would rather read a
mystery story
- I can’t agree with you. I think they
are too boring.
<i><b>c. - I like walking in the rain too. It </b></i>
feel so refreshing
- I agree they look so pretty
d.I agree, but if you don’t eat all the
time, it won’t hurt you
Close pair: Sts make similar
dialogues referring the cues on page
140 (below the dialogue) to replace
the information
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
- Open pair:
<b>* Homework: </b>
- Writes complete dialogues in your notebooks
- Do the exercises in the workbook page….
the board
<b>Unit 15: computer</b>
<i><b>Teaching date 23 / 04 /2009. </b></i>
<b>Period 94. </b>
<b>Lesson 3: read</b>
<b>A / The aims :</b>
<b>I . Teaching points :By the end of the lesson, students will be able to know more about how</b>
computers work in a university.
- Develop Ss’ reading skill.
<b>II. Teaching aids : Textbooks , poster , cassette , CD, lesson plan,word square chart . </b>
pictures , drawing .
<b>B/ Steps of the lesson: </b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up :</b>
- Asks Ss to go to the board to retell the main structure grammar of last lesson.
-T corrects and give them marks.
III. New lesson:
<b>I/</b>
<b>*Warm- up:</b>
<b>Jumbled words</b>
- Puts the cardboards on the board
- Divides the class into two teams and
asks each team to go to the board to write
their answer as fast as possible
<b>*. Pre - reading:</b>
+ Pre-teach vocabulary:
- Elicits the words from sts
- sts copy these words:
Checking technique:
What and where:
1. terpirn printer
2. seumo mouse
3. recsne screen
4. nimorot monitor
5. bdoaryke keyboard
6. moseu dap mouse pad
<b>* Read: </b>
<b>*Vocabulary</b>
- store (v): lu tr÷.
have access to a computer:Đ ờng dẫn
- make requirement for:đặt ra y/c với
- send messages (v): gửi thông báo.
- be skeptical about : Hoài nghi về ....
<i>- get a degree : đạt đợc bằng cấp, nhận </i>
bằng.
<b>II/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b>V/</b>
+ Open prediction:
- Introduces the topic of the text
- Asks sts to guess what they are going to
read
- Writes the sts’ guesses on the board
- Asks sts to read the text to check if their
guesses are correct or not
<b>*While-reading:</b>
+True / False statements:
- Sts read the text again then read the True
or False statements and decide if the
statements are true or false
- Calls on some sts to give their answers
and corrects the false statements
- Have sts to copy all the right statements
in their notebooks
<b>* Post – reading:</b>
+ Comprehension questions:
- Sts read the questions on page 147 and
find the information in the text to answer
- Sts compare their answers with their
partners
- Calls on some sts to give their answers
for the class
- Gives feedback and corrects
<b>* Consolidation: - Retell the main points </b>
of this lesson
<b>* Homework: </b>
Write the answers in your notebooks
- freshmen : SV năm thứ nhất
<i><b>* Checking: slap the board</b></i>
<b>* Suggested questions: </b>
1. Where in the library do we get / find
information?
2. How can we store the information?
3. If we want to discuss something, how
can we do?
<i><b>Answer key: </b></i>
a. True
b. True
c. True
d. False ( Sts don’t have to go to
computer rooms because college
campuses now have computer jacks in
every part of the university)
e. True
f. True
<b>*Comprehension questions:</b>
<i><b>Answer key: </b></i>
a. It has no library. All the information
normally found in a library is now
stored in the university’s computers.
b. All the information normally found
in a library or massages normally
found on a bulletin board
<b> Period 95. </b>Trả và chữa bài kiểm tra
-
-
<b>ỏp ỏn ting anh 8</b>
<b>1. following</b>
<b>2. completed</b>
<b>3. was sleeping</b>
<b>4. were………..doing</b>
<b>5. were playing</b>
<b>6. was doing /was reading</b>
<b>1. She said to her mother: Are you alright ?</b>“ ”
<b>2. He asked me whether I was a journalist or not.</b>
<b> </b>
<b> IV. 2 ®iĨm</b>
<b> 1. bored </b> <b>3. is always borrowing - never remembers </b>
<b>Period 96. </b>
By the end of the lesson, students will be able to write a set of instructions on how to
use the printer and complete a flow chart.
<b>I/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>1 .</b>
2/
<b>I. Pre- writing:</b>
*. Pre-teach vocabulary:
- Uses the picture on page 142 to elicit
words from sts.
- Have sts to copy
<b>Checking technique: * Matching </b>
- Asks sts to look at exercise 1 (p. 142)
and do the matching
- Gets some sts to give their answers
and corrects
*Gap fill: - Gets sts to make use of
some phrasal verbs
- Puts the words on the board and asks
sts to fill in the gaps with the right
words if possible
- Asks sts to look at the pictures on page
143 and read the cues
- Sts work in pairs to outline the
instructions
- Calls on some sts to say out the
instructions first ( 1 or 2 sts for each
sentence)
- Asks sts to write the instructions in
their notebooks
- Have sts to read their writing before
the class
- Gives feedback and corrects.
* Pre-teach:- Puts the flow chart on the
board and have sts to copy it into their
exercise books
- Gets sts to understand how events are
sequenced in a flow chart and the
meanings of all the shapes used in the
chart.
<b>2. While- listening: </b>
* Gap fill:
- Asks sts to look at the flow chart and
<b>* Write:</b>
<i>- paper input tray : khay đặt giấy vào </i>
<i>m¸y</i>
<i>- power button: nút khởi động</i>
<i>- output path: đờng dẫn giấy (đã </i>
<i>in) ra</i>
<i>- remove ( to put st away): cÊt ®i, di </i>
<i>chun</i>
<i><b>Answer key: </b></i>
a. 3 b. 1 c. 6
d. 2 e. 4 f. 5
<b>Phrasal verbs</b>
- wait for so/sth
- to remove sth
- to turn on/off a machine
- to plug in sth
- to load sth
<i><b>Answer key: </b></i>
1. to wait…for…….(sbd / sth)
2. to remove… .(sth)…
3. to turn …on / off……(a machine)
4. to plug…… …in .(sth)
5. to load…… ..(sth)…
<b>- Plug in the printer and turn on</b>
<b>- Remove the old paper and load</b>
<b>the new paper in the paper input</b>
<b>tray</b>
<b>- Wait for the power button to</b>
<b>flash</b>
<b>- Have the pages appear on the</b>
<b>computer screen.</b>
<b>- Click the printer icon on the</b>
<b>screen and wait for a few seconds</b>
<b>- The printed paper will come out</b>
<b>of the output path in a minute.</b>
<b>* Listen:</b>
Starting / stopping point
(circle)
3/
***
guess the words in the gaps
- Plays the tape (2 or 3 times) and asks
sts to listen
- Tells sts to fill the gaps with the
information they have heard from the
tape
- Sts compare the answers with their
partners
- Calls on some sts to go to the board to
write their answers
- Gives feedback and corrects
- Have sts to copy
* Write it up: - Sts write a set of
instructions on how to get a drink from
a machine, using the flow chart
- Do the exercises on page …
(triangle)
Answers
(oval)
<i><b>Answer key: </b></i>
- start
- find a machine
<b>a. Do you have the correct change?</b>
<b>b. Yes</b>
<b>c. What do you want to drink?</b>
- Lemon soda
- Insert coins and press button
d. Take it.
Let students do the exercises in the
workbook
- Prepare well for the next lesson.
<b>Period 97. </b>
<b>I.Teaching points : - By the end of the lesson , Ss will be able to use “ yet “ and “ </b>
already “ to express the present perfect . They will be able to use present perfect to
express complete and incomplete actions and recognize the difference between the
present perfect and past simple
- Develop Ss’ four skills.
<b>II. Preparation: -Text books, lesson plan, posters .</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up: -Asks Ss to retell the new words and read again the dialogue.</b>
- Two others to retell the main structure grammar .
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>***</b>
What’s your job?
- Calls on a student to go to the
board and give him /her a job name
- Asks the rest of the class to guess
- Tells sts someone who can guess
the right job will get a point and take
the place of the last chosen student.
<b>* </b>
- Asks sts to look at the information
<b>Example questions:</b>
+ Do you work with children?
+ Do you wear uniform?
+ Do you travel a lot?
+ …………..
<b>* Language focus 2:</b>
<i>T: Has the flight to Vientiane departed </i>
yet?
S: Yes, it has already departed.
T: Has the flight from Los Angeles
arrived yet?
S: No, it hasn’t arrived yet
..
<b>II/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b>IV/</b>
<b> V/</b>
VI/
tables and asks questions to show
the models.
- Asks sts to take in turns to ask and
answer the questions
- Call son some sts to demonstrate
the exchanges in front of the class
- Gives feedback and corrects.
<b>* Presentation:</b>
Use Vietnamese to elicit the models:
<b>*. Practice: </b>
* Grammar drill:
- Asks sts to look at the table on
page 146 , read the sentences and
check () the correct column
- Calls on sts to give their answers
- Gives feedback and corrects
<b>* Presentation</b>
* Revision:
- Puts the chart on the board and
asks sts to read the sentences
- Asks sts to decide which sentence
is in the present perfect and which is
past simple
- Calls on sts to give their answers
- Gives feedback and corrects
<b>* Practice: </b>
<b>*. Grammar drill:</b>
- Asks sts to complete the dialogue
on page 146 orally
- Calls on some pairs to give their
answers
- Gives feedback and corrects
- Has some pairs to demonstrate the
dialogues for the class
- Pronunciation correction
<b>* Production:* Writing: </b>
- Asks sts to write 4 sentences of
their own 2 in the past simple and 2
in the present perfect
- Have some of them write their
sentences on the board for public
check and give them points if
possible
<b>* </b>
<b> Language focus 3:</b>
1. I ‘ve ever been to Da lat (finished)
<b>2. My parents have gone to Da lat for 3</b>
days (incomplete)
Concept check:
<b>Present perfect tense:</b>
Use:
- Finished actions indefinite time
- incomplete actions for, since,
recently ………..
Form
Finished
action Incomplete
action
a. I’ve been to…
b. They have lived..
c. She has …
d. He has….
e. We have found…
f. Someone has…
g. People have….
<b>* </b>
<b> Language focus 4:</b>
Chart:
1. Her family moved to Ha Noi 2 years
ago
2. He has never met such an intelligent
boy before
3. My brother has become more
independent since he left home
4. When did the Second World War
break out?
Answer key:
1. Past simple finished action with
definite time
2. Present perfect an action (not) taking
3. Has become: Present perfect same as
number 2
Left: past simple finished action with
understood definite time
4. Past simple (same as number 1)
<i><b>Answer key: </b></i>
1. have….seen / did…….see / saw
2. haven’t had / 3. have been
4. have…….heard / 5. happened
6. had / 7. fell / 8. broke
Do some exercises in workbooks.
<b>Period 98 . </b>
<b> </b>
<b>I.Teaching points : By the end of the lesson, students will be able to use present </b>
perfect to express complete and incomplete actions and recognize the difference
between the present perfect and past simple and express the present perfect
<b>II. Preparation: -Text books, lesson plan, posters .</b>
<b>I. Organization: - Greeting and checking attendance.</b>
<b>II. Checking up: -Asks Ss to retell the new words and read again the dialogue.</b>
- Two others to retell the main structure grammar .
- Teacher corrects and give them marks.
<b>III. New lesson:</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>II/</b>
<b>***</b>
<b>III/</b>
*
<i><b>+. Sets the scene: </b></i>
<i>“ Ba s mother has just been </i>’
<i>back from market. She wanted </i>
<i>done. Look at Ba s diary </i>’ ”
- Shows the chart (Ba’s diary)
on the board
- Asks questions and elicits the
answers from the sts
- Has sts to repeat and write
their sentences on the board
- Has sts to copy.
- Asks sts to look at the
information tables and asks
questions to show the models.
- Asks sts to take in turns to ask
and answer the questions
- Call son some sts to
demonstrate the exchanges in
front of the class
- Gives feedback and corrects.
- Call son some sts to
demonstrate the exchanges in
front of the class
- Gives feedback and corrects.
<b>La* Language focus 1:</b>
<b>Present perfect with Yet and already </b>
<b>- Yet : used in questions and negative </b>
statements
<b>- Already : used in positive statements </b>
<b>+ Yet : at the end of the sentence . </b>
<b>+ Already : between auxiliary have and past </b>
<b>participle</b>
<i><b>T: Has Ba done his homework yet?</b></i>
<i><b>S: Yes, he has already done his homework</b></i>
<i><b>T: Has Ba tidied the room yet?</b></i>
<i><b>S: No, he has not tidied the room yet</b></i>
<b>* Language focus 2:</b>
Model sentences:
<i>T: Has the flight to Vientiane departed yet?</i>
<i>S: Yes, it has already departed.</i>
T: Has the flight from Los Angeles arrived
yet?
S: No, it hasn’t arrived yet
..
………
* Comparisons :
<b>Present perfect tense </b> <b>Past simple</b>
<b>Use : - finished actions </b>
with indefinite time
- incomplete actions
with “for , since ,
Finished action with
definite time .
Page 185 School year : 2010- 2011
<b>IV/</b>
<b> V/</b>
<b>* Presentation:</b>
Use Vietnamese to elicit the
models:
<b>*. Practice: </b>
* Grammar drill:
- Asks sts to look at the table on
page 146 , read the sentences
and check () the correct
column
- Calls on sts to give their
answers
- Gives feedback and corrects
<b>* Presentation</b>
* Revision:
- Puts the chart on the board
and asks sts to read the
sentences
- Asks sts to decide which
sentence is in the present
perfect and which is past
simple
- Calls on sts to give their
answers
- Gives feedback and corrects
<b>* Practice: </b>
<b>*. Grammar drill:</b>
- Asks sts to complete the
dialogue on page 146 orally
- Calls on some pairs to give
their answers
- Gives feedback and corrects
- Has some pairs to
demonstrate the dialogues for
the class
<b>* Consolidation: </b>
- Retell the main points of this
lesson.
Write the questions and
answers into your exercise
books
Do some exercises
recently”
<b>Form : Have / has + Past </b>
participle
* Present perfect or past simple tenses :
<b>* Language focus 3:</b>
1. I ‘ve ever been to Da lat (finished)
<b>2. My parents have gone to Da lat for 3</b>
days (incomplete)
<b>* Present perfect tense:</b>
Use:
- Finished actions indefinite time
- incomplete actions for, since, recently
..
………
Finished
action Incomplete
action
a. I’ve been to…
b. They have lived..
c. She has …
d. He has….
e. We have found…
f. Someone has…
g. People have….
<b>* Language focus 4:</b>
Chart:
1. Her family moved to Ha Noi 2 years ago
2. He has never met such an intelligent boy
before
3. My brother has become more independent
since he left home
4. When did the Second World War break
out?
Answer key:
1. Past simple finished action with definite
time
2. Present perfect an action (not) taking place
from the past to the present
3. Has become: Present perfect same as
number 2
Left: past simple finished action with
understood definite time
4. Past simple (same as number 1)
<i><b>Answer key: </b></i>
1. have….seen / did…….see / saw
2. haven’t had / 3. have been / 4.
have…….heard
<b>Period 99. </b>
<b>Time</b> <b> SS' and teacher's activities</b> <b>contents</b>
<b>I/</b>
<b>***</b>
- Divides class into 2 teams
- Tells sts the team raising their
hands first ( after the teacher
finishes the questions) will have
<b>* Suggestions:</b>
1. Steam engine Thomas Savery built
the first steam engine in 1698 and later
Watt improved it
2. Light bulb Humphry Davy, an
English scientist, in 1800
<b>II/</b>
<b>III/</b>
<b> IV/</b>
the right to answer the question
- Informs the questions:
<b>“ Who was the inventor </b>
<b>of……… ”?</b>
<b>or Who </b>“
<b>invented………?</b>
- Get sts to look at the pictures on
page 147 and asks them some
questions to evaluate how much
they understand the pictures
- Asks sts to read the sentences (A
to E) and match them with the
correct pictures
- Calls on some sts to give their
answers
- Gives feedback and corrects
**Pre teach vocabulary:
- Elicits words from sts
Checking technique:
Slap the board
+Open prediction:
- Set the scene:
<i>“ Tim, Hoa s American penpal, is </i>‘
<i>visiting a chocolate factory with </i>
<i>his class and his teacher, Mrs, </i>
<i>Allen. Now guess who will show </i>
<i>them around the factory and what </i>
<i>they will learn from this visit” </i>
- Writes the sts’ prediction on the
board
- Plays the tape and asks sts to
listen while reading the dialogue
on page 148
- Asks sts to match the half
sentences on page 149
- Sts compare their answer with
their partners
- Calls on some sts to give their
answer for the class
- Gives feedback and corrects
- Gets sts to write the full
sentences in their notebooks
+ Grid:
- Puts the gird on the board and
have sts to copy
- Asks sts to read the dialogue
again and fill in the grid
3. Sewing machine Isaac Meritt Singer
(1850)
4. Aqualung Jacques – Yves
Cousteau in b1943
5. Telephone A. Graham Bell
<b>* Getting started:</b>
Suggestions:
- Where are they from? (picture a, b, c, e)
- What is it ? (d)
Answer key:
A. b) D. a) B. c) E. d) C. e)
<b>1. Vocabulary</b>
- crush (v) Ðp, nghiỊn
- liquefy (v) ho¸ láng
- grind (v) (ground - ground) xay, nghiÒn
nhá
- manufacture (v) = produce : sản xuất
- process (n) Quá trình, tiến trình
- mold (n) khuân
- conveyor belt (n) bng chuyn
- foreman: quản đốc phân xởng, đốc
công
<i><b>Answer key: </b></i>
E - a) The beans are cleaned before
being cooked
D – b) Mr. Robert thought Tim and Sam
C – c) After cooking, the cocoa bean
smell like chocolate
F – d) Sugar is one of the ingredients in
chocolate
B – e) Mrs. Allen warned Sam to leave
some chocolate for others
A – f) A sample of chocolate is given
after visitors have toured the factory
<b>Chocolate manufacturing</b>
<b>process</b>
<i><b> Answer key: </b></i>
1. The beans are washed, weighed and
cooked
2. The shells are removed
3. The beans are crushed and liquefied
4. Cocoa butter, sugar, vanilla and milk
are added
5. The mixture is ground, rolled and
poured into the molds
<b>* Language focus 1:</b>
- Revise the passive form
* Change into passive :
1. The document was typed by Mrs
Quyen
<b>V/</b> - Calls some pairs to go to the
board to write their answers
- Gives feedback and corrects.
Rewrite the grid using sequence
markers
( First, next, then, finally…)
3. The picture was drawn by Ba
4. The lights were turned off by Hoa
5. The cake was baked by Lan
- copydown homeworks.
<b>Period 100. </b>
I / The aims:
Further practice in seeking information about famous places or people using
“Yes / No” questions both in “direct speech” and “indirect speech”
- Listening for details by deliberating the mistakes.
<b>II.The teaching aids : </b>
- Text books, lesson plan, chalks, CD player and records,...
<b>III. The teaching procedure:</b>
<b>A.Class organizing: </b>- Greetings
- Checking attendances
8A : /29
8B : /28
8C : /33
8D : /30
8E : /30
<b>B.</b>New lesson:
<b>1,Warm </b>–<b> up:</b>
Teacher asks students 10 yes/no
questions about 10 places
<b>2.Pre- stages:</b>
- T presents vocab
* Chatting:
<b>Questions</b> <b>Places</b>
1. Is the Great Wall in England ? No/ China
2. Is Stonehenge in England Yes
3. Is Phong Nha Cave in Vietnam Yes
4. Is Mount Everest in Nepal ? Yes
5. Is the Empire State Building in
San Francisco ? No/ New York
6.Is Ha Long Bay in Southern VN? Yes
7. Is Hue Citadel a World Heritage Yes
8. Is Big Ben in France ? No/ England
9. Is Great Barrier Reef a World
Heritage ? Yes
10. Is Eiffel Tower in Australia ? No/ France
<b>I.Vocabulary</b>
- Students read the advertisement and
try to guess the mistakes
- Ss take notes in reported speech with
yes/no questions
- Sts notice the changes
<b>3.Practice:</b>
- Student use the questions in the warm
up stage and report them (groups of
three)
- Students listen to the tape then check
their predictions
- Students listen again then give their
answers
<b>4.Production:</b>
- Students write the reported speech in
their notebooks
<b>5.Home work:</b>
- Give tasks
- an inn (n) Qu¸n trä
- a jungle (n) Rừng rậm nhiệt đới
- a rain forest (n) Rừng ma nhiệt đới
- Crystal clear (adj) trong suốt nh pha lê
- Coral sea (n) Bin san hụ
- Snokel (v) Bơi lặn có sư dơng èng thë
<i><b>* Read the advertisement :(Listen P.133)</b></i>
<b>* Reported speech with yes/no questions</b>
<i><b>Model sentences</b></i>
I said to Lan"Is the Great Wall in England ?"
I asked Lan if/whether the Great Wall is
in England
<b>Form: S + asked + (O) if/whether S + V</b>
<i><b>* Notice the changes:</b></i>
say asked
question statement
Simple present simple past
Eg: I asked Tung if/whether Stonehenge
was in England. He said it was
<b>II. Practice :</b>
<b>1. Speaking :</b>
Eg:
Lan : Is Phong Nha Cave in Vietnam?
Hoa: Yes
Ha: Lan asked Hoa if/whether Phong Nha
Cave was in Vietnam. She said it was
<b>2. Listening :</b>
*Key :
Southern -> Far North
Inn -> Hotel
Jungle-> rainforest
6824 -> 6924
<b>3. Reporting :</b>
Eg: Tung asked Hien if/whether Big Ben
was in France. She said it wasn't. It was in
England
Period : 85
Date of preparing: 19/3/ 08
Date of teaching:
<b>Lesson 3 : read</b>
<b>I.The objectives:</b>
- Reading for detail of the text about the wonders of the world
<b>II.The teaching aids : </b>
- Text books, lesson plan, chalks, CD player and records,...
<b>III. The teaching procedure:</b>
<b>A.Class organizing: </b>- Greetings
- Checking attendances
8A : /29
8B : /28
8C : /33
8D : /30
8E : /30
<b>B.</b>New lesson:
<b>1,Warm </b>–<b> up:</b>
- T erminds them of the wonders of the
world they have known
<b>2.Pre- reading :</b>
- Preteach vocabulary
- Checking vocab
-T sets the scene
<b>3.while </b>–<b> reading :</b>
-Sts read the text then check their
predictions
- Students read again and then do the
<b>* Brainstorm :</b>
<b>The wonders of the world</b>
The Hanging Garden of Babylon/ Iraq
The Statue of Zeus/ Greece
Angkor Wat/ Cambodia
The Taij Mahal/ India
The Lighthouse Alexandria
The Statue of Jupiter/ Greece
The Actimitst's temple/ Turkey
The Statue of Apollon/ Greece
<b>I. Vocabulary:</b>
- Compile (v) Biên soạn, tập hợp
- Claim (v) Khẳng định, tuyên bố
- Honor (v) Thờ
- Survive (v) Tån t¹i, sèng sãt
- God (n) Chúa
- Religious (adj) Thuộc tôn giáo
- Royal (adj) hoµng téc, hoµng gia
<i><b>* slap the board :</b></i>
<b>* Read : (P.134)</b>
<i><b>* Open prediction : Seven wonders of the </b></i>
wolrd
1. The Hanging Garden of Babylon/ Iraq
2. The Statue of Zeus/ Greece
3. The Pyramids of Cheops
4. The Lighthouse Alexandria
5. The Statue of Jupiter/ Greece
6. The Statue of Apollon/ Greece
7. The Actimitst's temple/ Turkey
exercise 1
<b>4.Post- reading :</b>
- Lucky numbers
<b>5.Home work:</b>
- Give tasks
a, C b, A
c, D d, B
<b>* Lucky numbers (2,4 are lucky numbers)</b>
1. Where is The Golden Gate Bridge ? (San
Francisco)
3. Which is the longest structure in the
world ? (The Great Wall)
6. Which is the largest temple of the
world ? (Angkor Wat)
6. How long is the Great Wall of China ?
(over 6.000km)
7. Where is Angkor Wat ? (Cambodia)
- Let students do the exercises in the
workbook
- Prepare well for the next period
Period : 86
Date of preparing: 19/3/ 08
Date of teaching:
<b>Lesson 4 : write</b>
<b>I.The objectives:</b>
- By the end of the lesson, students will be able to know how to write a
narrative
<b>II.The teaching aids : </b>
- Text books, lesson plan, chalks,...
<b>III. The teaching procedure:</b>
<b>A.Class organizing: </b>- Greetings
- Checking attendances
8A : /29
8C : /33
<b>B.</b>New lesson:
<b>1,Warm </b>–<b> up:</b>
- Ss repeat
- Give feedback
<b>2.Pre- writing :</b>
- Preteach vocabulary
-Ss read the letter and then complete the
letter by matching.
<b>3.while-writing :</b>
- Students read the outline and prepare
to write a letter
- Sts write the letters
- T gives sample
<b>4.Post </b>–<b> wriring :</b>
- Work in groups and correct
<b>5.Home work:</b>
- Give tasks
<b>*Brainstorm</b>
How to describe a place
- Name
- Weather
- Sights
- Accommodation
- How to go there
<b>Vocabulary</b>
- ranger (n) Ngêi b¶o vƯ rõng, qu¶n lí công
viên
- edge (n) Cạnh , mép
- canyon (n) hẻm nói
- breathtaking (adj) hấp dẫn, ngoạn mục
- stone age (n) Thời kì đồ đá
<b>* Matching: (Write 1. P.135)</b>
1. C 2. B 3. D 4. A
<b>Outline</b>
- Place:( Ha Long Bay, Cuc Phuong
National Park)
- Distance: ( about 100km, 12 hours
by train…)
- Sights: (beautiful, breathtaking…)
- Weather: (temperate, sunny, cool…)
- How do you feel (happy, relaxed…)
E.g :
(date, month)
Dear……,
How are you ? I hope you and your family
still has a good health and you will have a
good result for your exam.
My family has just return from a trip to Ha
Long Bay. It is a world heritage site. We
There are many beautiful limestone islands
and magnificent caves.
That’s all I have time to tell you about.
What do you plan to do during the summer
vaccation ? Write to me.
Your friend,
(Signature)
- Let students do the exercises in the
workbook
- Prepare well for the next period
Period : 87
Date of preparing:19/3/ 08
Date of teaching:
<b>Lesson 5 : language focus 1,2,4</b>
<b>I.The objectives:</b>
- By the end of the lesson, students will be able to use the past simple passive
<b>II.The teaching aids : </b>
- Text books, lesson plan, chalks, ...
<b>III. The teaching procedure:</b>
<b>A.Class organizing: </b>- Greetings
- Checking attendances
8A : /29
8B : /28
8C : /33
8D : /30
8E : /30
<b>B.</b>New lesson:
<b>1,Warm </b>–<b> up:</b>
- Ss play a game “bingo” with vocab
<b>2.Presentation:</b>
- Ss revise grammar : Passive form and
- Ss take notes : tha changes
<b>BINGO</b>
temperate, breathtaking, royal, religious,
canyon, pyramids, edge, god, jungle,
compile
<b>Passive</b>
Was/ were + V.pp
Ex: A shirt was bought yesterday
<b>Reported speech</b>
<i>Model sentences</i>
I said to Lan " Is the Great Wall in England
?"
I asked Lan if/whether the Great Wall in
England
<b>3.Practice:</b>
- Ss do exercises : language focus 1,2,4
- Give answers
<b>4.Production:</b>
- Ss do transformation exercise
<b>5.Home work:</b>
- Give tasks
say asked
question statement
Simple present simple past
<b>Language focus 1:</b>
a. was completed
b. was constructed
c. was designed
d. was presented
e. was reached
<b>Language focus 2:</b>
a. Nhi asked Nga if it was far from Ha
Noi
b. Nhi asked Nga whether My Son was
in Quang Nam province
c. Nhi asked Nga if many people lived
at My Son
d. Nhi aske Nga whether many tourists
visited My Son every year
e. Nhi asked Nga if she wanted to visit
My Son once day
<i><b>Language focus 4: To </b></i>–<i> infi or bare infi</i>
8. to jog
9. go
10.to gather
11.to rain
12.to reach
13.to continue
14.get
<b>* Transformation :</b>
1. He said to me “Do you learn
English ?”
He asked me...
2. She did the test perfectly
The test...
- Prepare for the test
Period : 88
Date of preparing:28/3/ 08
Date of teaching:
<b>I.The objectives:</b>
- To revise all the knowledge needed to the test
- To prepare well for the test
<b>II.The teaching aids : </b>
- Text books, lesson plan,...
<b>III. The teaching procedure:</b>
<b>A.Class organizing: </b>- Greetings
- Checking attendances
8A : /29
8B : /28
8C : /33
8D : /30
8E : /29
<b>1. warm up</b>
The present perfect tense
<b>2. Presentation</b>
a. Passive form
( Widen to modal verb such as can,
will, coul, shall, may, must..)
b. Reported speech
(Statements, yes/no questions)
<b>3. Practice</b>
Students do the exercises given by the
teacher
1. They (buy) that car recently
2. She (already/do) her homework
1. have bought
2. has already done
3. Has he seen
1. Passive form
Act: S + V + O
Pass: S + be + Vpp + by O
Note: Tense of the verb “be” depending on
the verb and the O in the active sentence
Ex: She cooks breakfast everymorning
Breakfast is cooked every morning (by
her)
1. She told that story
2. They have built that house for a long
time
3. He wrote a letter yesterday
4. They can reuse the empty bottles
2. Reported speech
a. He said “ I am a plumper”
b. She said “Is the Great Wall in China ?”
<b>4. Production</b>
- Reading
- Pronunciation
<b>5. Homework</b>
The reading passages of unit 10 to unit 14
(recycling, traveling a round Vietnam, A
vacation abroad, festiaval, wonders of the
world )
The pronounciation of vowels : A, E, I, O,
U and consonants
- Prepare for the test
Period : 89
Date of preparing:28/3/ 08
<b>I.The objectives:</b>
- To carry out professional regulations
- To check Ss’s understandings
- To find out more effective methods of teaching.
<b>II.The teaching aids : </b>
- uestion sheets , keys,...
<b>III. The teaching procedure:</b>
- Checking attendances
8A : /29
8B : /28
8C : /33
8D : /30
8E : /29
<b>B.the test :</b>
<b>I. Questions: </b>
<b>I. Chọn đáp án đúng cho mỗi chỗ trống bằng cách khoanh trịn vào đáp án A,B,C </b>
<b>hoặc D để hồn thành câu:</b>
1. Who was you...on the telephone when I came in?
A. talk B.talking C.to talk D. talked
2. HaLong bay... as a world heritage site by UNESCO.
A. recognizes B.recognized C.is recognized D. was recognized
3. Would you ...giving me some informations about Singapore tours?
A. mind B. like C. know D. interest
4. The cartoon character Mickey Mouse... by Walt Disney
A. created B.is created C. was created D. was creating
5. Singing contest ... in our schoolyard tomorrow afternoon.
A. is held B. will be held C. was held D. is holding
6. At Tet holiday, almost Vietnamese houses ... .
A. are redecorated or repainted B. redecorated or repainted
C. are redecorate or repainted D. are redecorating or painting
7. He... to the best student in our school
A. is saying B. is said C. said D. says
8. Ngan asked me ... Halong Bay was in Northern Viet Nam.
A. as B. if C. so D. that
9. Could you please tell me how...a sticky rice cake?
A. to make B. is making C. make D. to be made
10.She asked me whether I ...Sa Pa
A. know B. to know C. knew D. were knowing
<b>II. Đọc đoạn văn sau rồi chọn đáp án đúng bằng cách khoanh tròn vào đáp án </b>
<b>A,B,C hoặc D để hoàn thành các câu về đoạn văn :</b>
The Pyramid of Khufu (Cheops in Greece ) is the largest, oldest and only true
surviving member of the seven wonders of the Ancient World. It was built in the 26 th
century BC. It held the world’s tallest men - made structure title for over 4400 years
until 1889 when the Effel Tower was built.The base area of Khufu’s Pyramid is equal in
size to thatof six big – city blocks.Most of the chiseled stones used to build this
pyramid are as big as small pickup trucks. The rugged exterior we see today on
Pharaoh Khufu’s tomb was originally covered by a beautiful smooth limestone
surfacing.
11. The Pyramid of Khufu is one of the____________wonders of the Ancient World.
A. six B. eight C. seven D. nine
12. It was built in__________________
A. 2600 BC B. year 2600 C. the 26th<sub> century BC</sub> <sub>D. the year 2600</sub>
13. The Pyramid of Khufu was the world’s tallest man – made structure title
A. the Effel Tower was built B. today C. 26th<sub> century BC </sub> <sub>D. 1989</sub>
14. The base area of Khufu’s Pyramid is as big as _____________________
A. six houses B. six trucks C. small pickup trucks D. six big-city blocks
15. What was the rugged exterior we see today on Pharaoh Khufu’s tomb was
originally covered by________________________?
A. a beautiful smooth gemstone surfacing
<b>IV. Khoanh tròn đáp án đúng A,B,C, hoặc D để chuyển những câu hỏi sau sang </b>
<b>câu gián tiếp :</b>
16. “Do you like English,Nga?”, My mother asked.
A. My mother asked her if she liked English
B. Her mother asked her if she liked English
C. My mother asked me if I liked English
D. My mother asked me if I like English
17. “ Have you ever been to Phong Nha cave?”, she asked Tom
A. She asked Tom if he had ever been to Phong Nha cave
B. She asked Tom whether he was in Phong Nha cave
C. She asked Tom if he went Phong Nha cave
D. She asked Tom if he has ever been to Phong Nha cave
18. “ What places have you already visited ?”,she asked me.
A. She wanted to know what places I already visited.
B. She wanted to know what places I had already visited.
C. She wanted to know what places I have already visited.
D. She wanted to know what places have I already visited.
<b>V. Hoàn thành các câu sau dựa vào từ gợi ý :</b>
19. Nga / say / she / visit Phong Nha cave / twice
-> ...
20 . I / ask / Tam / if / the Great Wall / in / China
-> ...
II. KEY: Total 10 marks (0,5 marks per correct number)
1. B
2. D
3.A
4. C
5. B
6. A
7. B
8. B
9. A
10.C
11. C
12. C
13. A
14. D
15.B
16.C
17. A
19. Nga / say / she / visit Phong Nha cave / twice
-> Nga said she had visitted PN cave twice
20 . I / ask / Tam / if / the Great Wall / in / China
-> I asked Tam if the Great Wall was in China
Period : 90
Date of preparing:5/4/ 08
Date of teaching:
<b>I.The objectives:</b>
- To help Ss find what they are false,and what mistakes they often make
- Consolidate what Ss haven’t yet reached.
- correct the test.
II. comments :
Good :
Fair :
Average :
Poor :
Weak :
15%
->85% of students reach the basic knowledge
-> Usage skills : 50 %
<b>III. guidline : </b>
- Reinforce regularly tests, exercises ,etc.
- Check students’ studying more often
<b>IV. The teaching procedure:</b>
<b>A.Class organizing: </b>- Greetings
- Checking attendances
8A : /29
8B : /28
8C : /33
8D : /30
8E : /30
<b>B.corrections :</b>
matters appearing in the test.
- Ss focus and correct their test on their
own
<b>I. Correction :</b>
1. Structure with “mind”
2,3,4,9,10. Passive forms
5,6. Indirected speech with “if/whether”
7. Past progressive tense with
“when/while”
8. “How” + to – infinitive